584190
6
Zoom out
Zoom in
Previous page
1/96
Next page
AV SURROUND RECEIVER
AVR-2808CI
Owners Manual
AVR2808CIEU.indd 1 2007/06/20 8:56:43
n
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
CAUTION
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK
DO NOT OPEN
CAUTION:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE
COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE.
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral
triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of
uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure
that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric
shock to persons.
The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended
to alert the user to the presence of important operating
and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature
accompanying the appliance.
WARNING:
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT
EXPOSE THIS APPLIANCE TO RAIN OR MOISTURE.
SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
1. Read Instructions – All the safety and operating instructions should be read
before the product is operated.
2. Retain Instructions – The safety and operating instructions should be
retained for future reference.
3. Heed Warnings All warnings on the product and in the operating
instructions should be adhered to.
4. Follow Instructions – All operating and use instructions should be followed.
5. Cleaning – Unplug this product from the wall outlet before cleaning. Do not
use liquid cleaners or aerosol cleaners.
6. Attachments Do not use attachments not recommended by the product
manufacturer as they may cause hazards.
7. Water and Moisture Do not use this product near water for example,
near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink, or laundry tub; in a wet basement;
or near a swimming pool; and the like.
8. Accessories – Do not place this product on an unstable cart, stand, tripod,
bracket, or table. The product may fall, causing serious injury to a child or
adult, and serious damage to the product. Use only with a cart, stand,
tripod, bracket, or table recommended by the manufacturer, or sold with the
product. Any mounting of the product should
follow the manufacturer’s instructions, and should
use a mounting accessory recommended by the
manufacturer.
9. A product and cart combination should be moved
with care. Quick stops, excessive force, and
uneven surfaces may cause the product and cart
combination to overturn.
10. Ventilation Slots and openings in the cabinet are provided for ventilation
and to ensure reliable operation of the product and to protect it from
overheating, and these openings must not be blocked or covered. The
openings should never be blocked by placing the product on a bed, sofa,
rug, or other similar surface. This product should not be placed in a built-in
installation such as a bookcase or rack unless proper ventilation is provided
or the manufacturer’s instructions have been adhered to.
11. Power Sources This product should be operated only from the type of
power source indicated on the marking label. If you are not sure of the type
of power supply to your home, consult your product dealer or local power
company. For products intended to operate from battery power, or other
sources, refer to the operating instructions.
12. Grounding or Polarization – This product may be equipped with a polarized
alternating-current line plug (a plug having one blade wider than the other).
This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature.
If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, try reversing the
plug. If the plug should still fail to t, contact your electrician to replace your
obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized plug.
13. Power-Cord Protection – Power-supply cords should be routed so that they
are not likely to be walked on or pinched by items placed upon or against
them, paying particular attention to cords at plugs, convenience receptacles,
and the point where they exit from the product.
15. Outdoor Antenna Grounding If an outside antenna or cable system is
connected to the product, be sure the antenna or cable system is grounded
so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static
charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70, provides
information with regard to proper grounding of the mast and supporting
structure, grounding of the lead-in wire to an antenna discharge unit, size
of grounding conductors, location of antenna-discharge unit, connection to
grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. See
Figure A.
16. Lightning For added protection for this product during a lightning storm,
or when it is left unattended and unused for long periods of time, unplug it
from the wall outlet and disconnect the antenna or cable system. This will
prevent damage to the product due to lightning and power-line surges.
17. Power Lines An outside antenna system should not be located in the
vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits, or
where it can fall into such power lines or circuits. When installing an outside
antenna system, extreme care should be taken to keep from touching such
power lines or circuits as contact with them might be fatal.
18. Overloading Do not overload wall outlets, extension cords, or integral
convenience receptacles as this can result in a risk of fire or electric shock.
19. Object and Liquid Entry Never push objects of any kind into this product
through openings as they may touch dangerous voltage points or short-out
parts that could result in a fire or electric shock. Never spill liquid of any kind
on the product.
20. Servicing Do not attempt to service this product yourself as opening or
removing covers may expose you to dangerous voltage or other hazards.
Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.
21. Damage Requiring Service – Unplug this product from the wall outlet
and refer servicing to qualified service personnel under the following
conditions:
a) When the power-supply cord or plug is damaged,
b) If liquid has been spilled, or objects have fallen into the product,
c) If the product has been exposed to rain or water,
d) If the product does not operate normally by following the operating
instructions. Adjust only those controls that are covered by the operating
instructions as an improper adjustment of other controls may result in
damage and will often require extensive work by a qualified technician to
restore the product to its normal operation,
e) If the product has been dropped or damaged in any way, and
f) When the product exhibits a distinct change in performance – this
indicates a need for service.
22. Replacement Parts When replacement parts are required, be sure the
service technician has used replacement parts specified by the manufacturer
or have the same characteristics as the original part. Unauthorized
substitutions may result in fire, electric shock, or other hazards.
23. Safety Check Upon completion of any service or repairs to this product,
ask the service technician to perform safety checks to determine that the
product is in proper operating condition.
24. Wall or Ceiling Mounting The product should be mounted to a wall or
ceiling only as recommended by the manufacturer.
25. Heat The product should be situated away from heat sources such as
radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other products (including amplifiers) that
produce heat.
FIGURE A
EXAMPLE OF ANTENNA GROUNDING
AS PER NATIONAL
ELECTRICAL CODE
"/5&//"
-&"%*/
8*3&
(306/%
$-".1
&-&$53*$
4&37*$&
&26*1.&/5
"/5&//"
%*4$)"3(&6/*5
/&$4&$5*0/
(306/%*/($0/%6$5034
/&$4&$5*0/
(306/%$-".14
108&34&37*$&(306/%*/(
&-&$530%&4:45&.
/&$"351"35)
/&$/"5*0/"-&-&$53*$"-$0%&
I
AVR2808CIEU.indd 2 2007/06/20 8:56:44
Avoid high temperatures.
Allow for sufficient heat dispersion when
installed in a rack.
Eviter des températures élevées.
Tenir compte d’une dispersion de chaleur
suffisante lors de l’installation sur une
étagère.
Handle the power cord carefully.
Hold the plug when unplugging the cord.
Manipuler le cordon d’alimentation avec
précaution.
Tenir la prise lors du débranchement du
cordon.
Keep the unit free from moisture, water,
and dust.
Protéger l’appareil contre l’humidité, l’eau
et la poussière.
Unplug the power cord when not using the
unit for long periods of time.
Débrancher le cordon d’alimentation
lorsque l’appareil n’est pas utilisé pendant
de longues périodes.
* (For apparatuses with ventilation holes)
Do not obstruct the ventilation holes.
Ne pas obstruer les trous d’aération.
Do not let foreign objects into the unit.
Ne pas laisser des objets étrangers dans
l’appareil.
Do not let insecticides, benzene, and
thinner come in contact with the unit.
Ne pas mettre en contact des insecticides,
du benzène et un diluant avec l’appareil.
Never disassemble or modify the unit in
any way.
Ne jamais démonter ou modifier l’appareil
d’une manière ou d’une autre.
n
NOTE ON USE / OBSERVATIONS RELATIVES A L’UTILISATION
II
FCC INFORMATION (For US customers)
1. PRODUCT
This product complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this
product may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this product must accept any interference received, including
interference that may cause undesired operation.
2. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS PRODUCT
This product, when installed as indicated in the instructions contained in this manual, meets FCC requirements.
Modification not expressly approved by DENON may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to use the product.
3. NOTE
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15
of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a
residential installation.
This product generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance
with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee
that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this product does cause harmful interference to radio or
television reception, which can be determined by turning the product OFF and ON, the user is encouraged to try to
correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.
• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
• Connect the product into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.
• Consult the local retailer authorized to distribute this type of product or an experienced radio/TV technician for
help.
This Class B digital apparatus complies with Canadian ICES-003.
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B est conforme à la norme NMB-003 du Canada.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 3 2007/06/20 8:56:45
Accessories ······················································································2
Cautions on Handling ·····································································3
Cautions on Installation ·································································3
About the Remote Control Unit ···················································· 3
Inserting the Batteries ···································································· 3
Operating Range of the Remote Control Unit ································3
Part Names and Functions ·····························································4
Front Panel ·····················································································4
Display ···························································································4
Rear Panel ······················································································5
Remote Control Unit ······································································6
Getting Started
Preparations ····················································································7
Cables Used for Connections ························································7
Video Conversion Function ·····························································8
On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and
HDMI Output ·················································································8
Speaker Connections ····································································· 9
Speaker Installation ········································································9
Speaker Connections ······························································· 9, 10
Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors ························· 11
Connecting the Monitor ······························································· 12
Connecting the Playback Components ······································ 12
DVD Player ··················································································· 12
Record Player ··············································································· 13
CD Player ····················································································· 13
iPod
®
···························································································· 14
TV/CABLE Tuner ··········································································· 14
Satellite Receiver ········································································· 15
Connecting the Recording Components ···································· 15
Digital Video Recorder ·································································· 15
Video Cassette Recorder ····························································· 16
CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck ····································· 16
Connections to Other Devices ····················································· 17
Video Camera / Game Console ···················································· 17
Component with Multi-channel Output connectors ····················· 17
External Power Amplifier ······························································ 17
XM connector ·············································································· 18
Antenna terminals ······································································· 18
Multi-zone ···················································································· 19
External Controller ······································································· 19
Connecting the Power Cord·························································20
Once Connections are Completed ·············································· 20
Connections
Preparations ··················································································23
Auto Setup ····················································································24
a Start Menu ··············································································24
Error Messages ·······································································25
s
Option ·····················································································25
d
Parameter Check ·····································································25
Auto Setup
Settings Related to Playing Input Sources ·································34
Auto Preset ··················································································34
Preset Skip ···················································································34
Preset Name ················································································34
Input Mode ··················································································34
Rename ························································································ 34
Assign ··························································································35
iPod ························································································35, 36
Other ····························································································36
Antenna Aiming ···········································································36
Input Setup
Contents
Speaker Setup···············································································26
a Speaker Configuration ·····························································26
s Subwoofer Setup ····································································26
d Distance ············································································26, 27
f Channel Level··········································································27
g Crossover Frequency ······························································27
HDMI Setup ··················································································· 27
a HDMI Audio Setup ··································································27
s HDMI Video Setup ··································································28
Audio Setup ··················································································28
a EXT. IN Subwoofer Level ·························································28
s 2ch Direct/Stereo ······························································ 28, 29
d Dolby Digital Setup ································································· 29
f Auto Surround Mode ······························································29
g Manual EQ ··············································································29
Zone Setup ···················································································· 30
a ZONE2 Setup ··········································································30
s ZONE3 Setup ··········································································30
Option Setup ·················································································31
a Amp Assign ·············································································31
s Volume Control ·······································································31
d Source Delete ·········································································31
f On-Screen Display ····························································31, 32
g Quick Select Name ·································································32
h Trigger Out ·············································································· 32
j Remote ID Setup ····································································32
k 2Way Remote ········································································· 32
l Display ····················································································32
A0 Setup Lock ··············································································33
Manual Setup
Operations ·····················································································20
Example of Display of Default Values ·········································21
Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display ····················21
Menu Map ····················································································· 22
Menu Operations
a Surround Parameter ··························································38 ~ 40
s Tone Control ·············································································· 40
d Room EQ ···················································································40
f RESTORER ················································································ 41
g Night Mode ···············································································41
h Audio Delay ···············································································41
Parameter
Standard Playback ········································································36
Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources ·······························36, 37
Playing Multi-channel Sources (Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.) ·············37
DSP Simulation Playback·····························································37
Stereo Playback ············································································37
Direct Playback ·············································································37
Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode ···········································38
Surround Modes
Status ····························································································41
a Main zone ···············································································41
s ZONE2 / ZONE3 ······································································41
Audio Input Signal ········································································42
HDMI Information ·········································································42
a HDMI Signal Information ························································ 42
s HDMI Monitor Information ····················································· 42
Auto Surround Mode ···································································· 42
Quick Select ·················································································· 42
Preset Station ··············································································· 42
Information
AVR2808CIEU.indd 4 2007/06/20 8:56:46
Check that the following parts are supplied with the product.
q Owner’s manual ......................................................................1
w Warranty (for North America model only) ................................ 1
e Service station list ................................................................... 1
r Power cord (Cord length: Approx. 7-31/64 ft /1.9 m) ................ 1
t Main remote control (RC-1068) ...............................................1
y LR6/AA batteries (for RC-1068) ................................................ 2
u Sub remote control (RC-1071) ................................................. 1
i R03/AAA batteries (for RC-1071) ............................................. 2
o FM indoor antenna .................................................................. 1
Q0 AM loop antenna ..................................................................... 1
Q1 Setup microphone (Cord length: Approx. 25 ft / 7.6 m) ............ 1
r t u
Q1
o
Q0
Thank you for purchasing this DENON product. To ensure proper
operation, please read these owner’s manual carefully before using
the product.
After reading them, be sure to keep them for future reference.
Getting Started
Accessories
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Preparations ··················································································43
Turning the Power On ··································································43
Selecting the input source ···························································43
Operations During Playback ·························································43
Playing Video and Audio Equipment ···········································44
Basic Operation ············································································44
Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts ················································· 44
Basic Operation ············································································44
Presetting Radio Stations (Preset Memory) ·································44
Listening to Preset Stations ·························································44
Listening to XM Satellite Radio Programs ·································45
Basic Operation ············································································45
Checking the XM Signal Strength and Radio ID ···························46
Searching Categories ···································································46
Accessing XM Radio Stations Directly ·········································46
iPod
®
Playback ············································································· 47
Basic Operation ············································································47
Listening to Music ··································································47, 48
Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the iPod ·································48
Playback
Main Remote Control Unit···························································51
Operating DENON Audio Components ········································ 51
Presetting ····················································································· 51
Operating Preset Components ············································51 ~ 53
Setting the Remote ID ·································································54
Learning Function ········································································· 54
System Call Function ····································································55
Punch Through Function ·······························································55
Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit ······································· 55
Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness ············································56
Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit ····································· 56
Sub Remote Control Unit Operations ········································ 56
Remote Control Unit Operations
Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function ·········57 ~ 59
Multi-zone Settings and Operations with Zone Pre-out Output ····59
Multi-zone Operations ································································· 60
Turning the Power On and Off······················································60
Selecting the Input Source ···························································60
Adjusting the Volume ···································································60
Turning off the Sound Temporarily ················································60
Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations
Troubleshooting ···································································70 ~ 72
Specifications ··············································································· 73
Other Information ································································61 ~ 69
Other Operations ·········································································· 48
Playing Super Audio CDs ·····························································48
Recording on an External Device (REC OUT mode) ·····················49
Convenient Functions ·································································· 50
Channel Level ···············································································50
Fader Function ·············································································50
Quick Select Function ··································································50
Personal Memory Plus Function ·················································· 50
Last Function Memory ·································································50
Backup Memory ···········································································50
Resetting the Microprocessor ······················································ 50
Other Operations and Functions
List of preset codes ··········································· End of this manual
AVR2808CIEU.indd 5 2007/06/20 8:56:46
In addition to the AVR-2808CI, the included main remote control unit
(RC-1068) can also be used to operate the equipment listed below.
q DENON system components
w Non-DENON system components
By setting the preset memory (vpage 51 ~ 53)
By using the learn function (vpage 54)
q Lift the clasp and remove the rear lid.
e Put the rear cover back on.
(RC-1068) (RC-1071)
(RC-1068) (RC-1071)
LR6/AA
R03/AAA
30°
30°
Approx. 23 feet / 7 m
or
(RC-1068)
(RC-1071)
w Load the two batteries properly as indicated by the marks in the
battery compartment.
About the Remote Control Unit
Inserting the Batteries
NOTE
Replace the batteries with new ones if the set does not operate even
when the remote control unit is operated close to the unit.
The supplied batteries are only for verifying operation.
When inserting the batteries, be sure to do so in the proper direction,
following the q” and w” marks in the battery compartment.
To prevent damage or leakage of battery fluid:
Do not use a new battery together with an old one.
Do not use two different types of batteries.
Do not attempt to charge dry batteries.
Do not short-circuit, disassemble, heat or dispose of batteries in
flames.
If the battery fluid should leak, carefully wipe the fluid off the inside
of the battery compartment and insert new batteries.
Remove the batteries from the remote control unit if it will not be in
use for long periods.
When replacing the batteries, have the new batteries ready and
insert them as quickly as possible.
Operating Range of the Remote Control
Unit
Point the remote control unit at the remote sensor when operating it.
NOTE
The set may function improperly or the remote control unit may not
operate if the remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight,
strong artificial light from an inverter type fluorescent lamp or infrared
light.
Before turning the power switch on
Check once again that all connections are correct and that there are
no problems with the connection cables.
Power is supplied to some of the circuitry even when the unit is
set to the standby mode. When traveling or leaving home for long
periods of time, be sure to unplug the power cord from the power
outlet.
About condensation
If there is a major difference in temperature between the inside of
the unit and the surroundings, condensation (dew) may form on
the operating parts inside the unit, causing the unit not to operate
properly.
If this happens, let the unit sit for an hour or two with the power
turned off and wait until there is little difference in temperature
before using the unit.
Cautions on using mobile phones
Using a mobile phone near this unit may result in noise. If so, move
the mobile phone away from this unit when it is in use.
Moving the unit
Turn off the power and unplug the power cord from the power
outlet.
Next, disconnect the connection cables to other system units before
moving the unit.
Note that the illustrations in these instructions may differ from the
actual unit for explanation purposes.
Note:
For proper heat dispersal, do not install this unit in a confined
space, such as a bookcase or similar enclosure.
b Note
b
Wall
b
b
Cautions on Handling
Cautions on Installation
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 6 2007/06/20 8:56:47
For buttons not explained here, see the page indicated in parentheses ( ).
q w e r
to i u y
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3
q Power operation button
(ON/STANDBY) ··········································· (43)
w Power indicator ··········································· (43)
e Power switch (hON jOFF) ····················· (43)
r QUICK SELECT buttons / indicators ········· (50)
t MASTER VOLUME control knob ················ (43)
y Master volume indicator
u Display
i Remote control sensor ································· (3)
o SOURCE SELECT knob······························· (43)
Q0 SOURCE button ·········································· (43)
Q1 TUNING PRESET button ···························· (44)
Q2 ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT button ·········· (49, 60)
Q3 VIDEO SELECT button ······························· (35)
Q4 Headphones jack (PHONES) ······················ (43)
Q5 ZONE2 ON/OFF button ······························ (60)
Q6 ZONE3 ON/OFF button ······························ (60)
Q7 INPUT MODE button ·································· (34)
Q8 MENU button ·············································· (20)
Q9 Cursor buttons (uio p) ·························· (20)
W0 CH SEL / ENTER button ······················· (20, 50)
W1 RETURN button ·········································· (20)
W2 V.AUX INPUT connectors ··························· (17)
W3 SETUP MIC jack ·········································· (23)
W4 ROOM EQ button ········································ (40)
W5 DIMMER button ·········································· (32)
W6 SPEAKER button ········································· (43)
W7 SURROUND BACK button ························· (40)
W8 STATUS button ··········································· (42)
W9 AUDIO DELAY button ································· (41)
E0 RESTORER button ······································ (41)
E1 DIRECT/STEREO button····························· (37)
E2 PURE DIRECT button ·································· (38)
E3 DSP SIMULATION button ·························· (37)
E4 STANDARD button ····································· (36)
q Input signal indicators
w Input signal channel indicators
These light when digital signals are input.
e Information display
The input source name, surround mode, setting
values and other information are displayed here.
r Output signal channel indicators
t Front speaker indicator
These light according to the settings of the front
A and B speakers.
y Master volume indicator
u AUDYSSEY MULTEQ XT indicator
This lights when the room equalizer is selected.
i Recording output source indicator
This lights when the REC OUT mode is
selected.
o NIGHT indicator
This lights when the night mode is selected.
Q0 Multi-zone indicators
These light when the power for the respective
zone is turned on.
Q1 RESTORER indicator
This lights when the RESTORER mode is
selected.
Q2 AL24 indicator
This lights when AL24 Processing Plus is
activated (vpage 63).
Q3 Input mode indicators
Q4 HDMI indicator
This lights when playing using HDMI
connections.
Q5 Decoder indicators
These light when the respective decoders are
operating.
Q6 Tuner reception mode indicators
These light according to the reception conditions
when the input source is set to “TUNER”.
AUTO
These light when in the auto tuning mode.
STEREO
In the FM mode, these light when receiving
analog stereo broadcasts.
TUNED
Lights when the broadcast is properly tuned in.
Part Names and Functions
Front Panel
Display
Q4
E4 E3 E2 E1 E0 W9 W8 W7 W6 W5 W4 W3
Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9 W0 W1 W2
GWith the door openH
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 7 2007/06/20 8:56:49
q w
Q4 Q5
e r t y
Q4
u i
oQ0Q1Q2Q3
Q6 Q7 Q6
q RS-232C connector ····································· (19)
w REMOTE CONTROL jacks··························· (19)
e TRIGGER OUT jacks ··································· (19)
r DOCK CONTROL jack ································· (14)
t Speaker terminals (SPEAKERS) ·················· (9)
y SIGNAL GND terminal ······························· (13)
u AC inlet (AC IN) ··········································· (20)
i AC OUTLETS ··············································· (20)
o Digital audio connectors
(OPTICAL / COAXIAL) ·························· (12, 15)
Q0 COMPONENT VIDEO connectors ·············· (12)
Q1 XM connector (SAT TU) ······························ (18)
Q2 HDMI connectors ·········································(11)
Q3 VIDEO / S-VIDEO connectors ···················· (12)
Q4 Analog audio connectors (AUDIO) ············ (12)
Q5 FM/AM antenna terminals
(TUNER ANTENNA) ···································· (18)
Q6 PRE OUT connectors ····························· (17, 19)
Q7 EXT. IN connectors ····································· (17)
Rear Panel
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 8 2007/06/20 8:56:51
q
i
w
e
r
t
y
u
o
Q1
Q3
Q4
Q2
Q0
Q5
Q6
Q7
Q9
W0
W2
W5
W7
W6
W4
W3
W1
Q8
q Signal transmission indicator ··················· (51)
w Mode select buttons ·································· (51)
e Quick select / System call buttons ····· (50, 55)
r Surround mode buttons ····················(36 ~ 38)
t System buttons ···································· (52, 53)
y Audio delay button (A. DL) ························ (41)
u Tuner system buttons ································ (44)
i Input mode button (INPUT) ······················· (34)
o MENU button ·············································· (20)
Q0 Cursor buttons (uio p) ························· (20)
Q1 Parameter / Search button
(PARA / SRCH) ································ (38, 46, 48)
Q2 HOME button ·············································· (51)
Q3 Channel buttons (CH) ································· (44)
Q4 Input source select / Number buttons ·· (43, 44)
Q5 Remote control signal transmitter ·············· (3)
Q6 Device select indicators (DEV1 / DEV2) ··· (51)
Q7 ZONE3 select indicators (Z3) ····················· (51)
Q8 RESTORER button (RSTR) ·························· (41)
Q9 Night button (NGT) ···································· (41)
W0 Test tone button (TEST) ····························· (27)
W1 Front speaker select button (SPKR) ·········· (43)
W2 POWER buttons ·········································· (43)
W3 Channel select (CH SEL) /
ENTER button ······································· (20, 50)
W4 Return button (RTN) ··································· (20)
W5 Master volume control buttons (VOL) ······ (43)
W6 Muting button (MUTE) ························· (43, 60)
W7 Main remote control unit setup button
(RC SETUP) ················································· (51)
q
i
o
Q0
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q4
w
e
r
t
y
u
q Remote control signal transmitter ·············· (3)
w Zone power off button (OFF) ····················· (60)
e CHANNEL buttons ······································ (56)
r TUNING buttons ········································· (56)
t System buttons ·········································· (56)
y REPEAT button ············································ (56)
u RANDOM button ········································ (56)
i ZONE2/ZONE3 select switch ····················· (56)
o Zone power on button (ON) ······················ (60)
Q0 Input source select buttons ······················· (60)
Q1 Volume control buttons (VOLUME) ·········· (60)
Q2 Muting button (MUTE) ······························· (60)
Q3 SHIFT button ··············································· (56)
Q4 FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY button ·············· (56)
n Main remote control unit (RC-1068) n Sub remote control unit (RC-1071)
The time for which the backlight stays on can
be changed (vpage 55 “Setting the Time the
Backlight Stays Lit”).
Remote Control Unit
NOTE
The M. SEL, DTU, NET/USB buttons cannot be
used.
The NET/DTU and ZONE2 mode QUICK SELECT (1
~ 3), A. DL, RSTR, NGT, INPUT, SPKR, TEST and
surround mode buttons cannot be used.
The ZONE4 mode cannot be used.
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 9 2007/06/20 8:56:53
Audio cables Video cables
Coaxial digital connections
(Orange)
Coaxial digital (75 Ω/ohms pin-plug) cable
Optical digital connections
Optical cable
Analog connections (stereo)
(White)
(Red)
R
L
R
L
Stereo pin-plug cable
Analog connections (monaural, for subwoofer)
(Black)
Pin-plug cable
Speaker connections
Speaker cables
Component video connections
(Green)
(Blue)
(Red)
(Y)
(PB/CB)
(PR/CR)
Component video cable
S-Video connections
S-Video cable
Video connections
(Yellow)
75 Ω/ohms pin-plug video cable
Audio and video cables
HDMI connections
19-pin HDMI cable
Signal direction
Audio signal: Video signal:
Output
Input
Input
Output
Output
Input
Input
Output
Connections
NOTE
Do not plug in the power cord until all connections have been
completed.
When making connections, also refer to the operating instructions of
the other components.
Be sure to connect the left and right channels properly (left with left,
right with right).
Do not bundle power cords together with connection cables. Doing
so can result in humming or noise.
Connections for all compatible audio and video signal formats are
described in these operating instructions. Please select the types
of connections suited for the equipment you are connecting.
With some types of connections, certain settings must be made
on the AVR-2808CI. For details, refer to the instructions for the
respective connection items below.
Cables Used for Connections
Select the cables according to the equipment being connected.
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Preparations
AVR2808CIEU.indd 10 2007/06/20 8:56:54
GFlow of video signals for ZONE2H
This function automatically converts various formats of video signals input to the AVR-2808CI into the
format used to output the video signals from the AVR-2808CI to a monitor.
The AVR-2808CI’s video input/output circuitry is compatible with the following four types of video
signals:
Digital video signals: HDMI
Analog video signals: Component video, S-Video and Video
Video Conversion Function
GFlow of video signals inside the AVR-2808CIH
Main zone
High picture
quality playback
HDMI connector
Component video
connectors
S-Video connector
Video connector
Monitor
HDMI connector
Component video
connectors
S-Video connector
Video connector
Video inputs Video outputs
: When 480i/576i signals are input in the main zone
S-Video connector
Video connector Video connector
Video inputs Video outputs
ZONE2
NOTE
HDMI signals cannot be converted into analog signals.
1080p component input video signals cannot be output to anything other than component video
connectors.
480p/576p, 1080i and 720p component video input signals cannot be converted into S-Video or Video
format.
When not using this function, connect a monitor output with the same type of connector as the video
input connector.
The resolution of the HDMI input-compatible monitor connected to the AVR-2808CI can be checked at
menu “Information” – “HDMI Signal Information” – “HDMI Monitor Information” (vpage 42).
High picture
quality playback
ZONE2
monitor
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
When viewing HDMI or component video signals via the AVR-2808CI, the on-screen display appears
when the MENU button or the main remote control unit´s PARA button is operated.
When only HDMI or component video signals are input to the AVR-2808CI, the characters of the on-
screen display are not displayed over the picture.
On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and HDMI
Output
AVR2808CIEU.indd 11 2007/06/20 8:56:54
Speaker Connections
w qw q
(R) (L)
w qw q
(R) (L)
w q
w q w q
(L) (R)
*/
w q w q
(L) (R)
The illustration below shows a basic example of installation of the amplifier combined with 8 speakers and
a monitor.
Speaker Installation
Subwoofer Center speaker
Surround speakers
Front speakers
Place the front speakers to the
sides of the monitor or screen and
as flush with the screen surface as
possible.
The table below shows a typical speaker configuration for the AVR-2808CI.
Surround back speakers
FRONT
CENTER
SURROUND SURROUND BACK
SUBWOOFER
L R L R L R 1 only
7.1-channels
(FRONT A+B)
S S S S S S S
S
7.1-channels
S S S S S S S
S
6.1-channels
S S S S S
S S
5.1-channels
S S S S S
S
3.1-channels
S S S
S
2.1-channels
S S
S
2-channels
S S
Speaker Connections
Example: 5.1-channels (FRONT A+B) and ZONE2 use
Front speakers
A
Center speaker Subwoofer
Subwoofer
with built-in
amplifier
Surround speakers ZONE2 speakers
ZONE2
When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL).
NOTE
By default, the AVR-2808CI’s Amp Assign” setting is set to “ZONE2”. To use as the surround back speaker
for the main zone, change the Amp Assign” setting (vpage 31).
b L : Left
R : Right
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Front speakers
B
AVR2808CIEU.indd 12 2007/06/20 8:56:57
Connecting the Speaker Cables
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and + (red) and
(black) polarities on the speakers being connected to the AVR-2808CI,
and be sure to interconnect the channels and polarities correctly.
1
Peel off about 0.03 ft/10 mm of sheathing
from the tip of the speaker cable, then
either twist the core wire tightly or
terminate it.
2
Turn the speaker terminal
counterclockwise to loosen it.
3
Insert the speaker cable’s core wire to
the hilt into the speaker terminal.
4
Turn the speaker terminal clockwise to
tighten it.
When using a banana plug
Tighten the speaker terminal firmly before
inserting the banana plug.
NOTE
Use speakers with an impedance of 6 to 16 Ω/ohms. When using
front A and B speakers simultaneously, use speakers with an
impedance of 8 to 16 Ω/ohms.
Connect the speaker cables in such a way that they do not stick out
of the speaker terminals. The protection circuit may be activated if
the core wires touch the rear panel or if the + and – sides touch each
other (v “Protection circuit”).
Never touch the speaker terminals while the power supply is
connected. Doing so could result in electric shock.
Protection circuit
If speakers with an impedance lower than specified (for example
4 Ω/ohms speakers) are used for an extended period of time with
the volume turned up high, the temperature may rise, activating the
protection circuit.
When the protection circuit is activated, the speaker output is shut
off and the power indicator ashes red. If this happens, unplug
the power cord, then check the speaker cable and input cable
connections. If the set is extremely hot, wait for it to cool off and
improve ventilation around it. Once this is done, plug the power cord
back in and turn the set's power back on.
If the protection circuit is activated again even though there are no
problems in the ventilation around the set nor in the connections,
the set may be damaged. Turn the power off, then contact a DENON
service center.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 13 2007/06/20 8:56:59

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
*/
)%.*
065
)%.*
Compatible
audio format
Details
Discs
(examples)
2-channel linear
PCM
2ch 32-192 kHz
16/20/24 bits
CD, DVD-Video,
DVD-Audio
Multi-channel
linear PCM
8ch 32-192 kHz
16/20/24 bits
DVD-Audio
Dolby Digital, DTS Bitstream DVD-Video
DSD
2/5.1ch
2.8224 MHz
1 bit
SACD
Dolby Digital Plus,
Dolby TrueHD,
DTS-HD
Bitstream
HD DVD,
Blu-ray Disc
MonitorDVD player
b The AVR-2808CI is equipped for HDMI version 1.3a.
This version is compatible with other versions, allowing
connection to all components equipped with an HDMI
connector.
b The AVR-2808CI is compatible with 30- and 36-bit Deep
Color.
Copyright protection system (HDCP)
In order to play the digital video and audio signals of a DVD-
Video or DVD-Audio disc using HDMI/DVI connections, both
the connected DVD player and monitor must be equipped
for a copyright protection system called “HDCP” (High-
bandwidth Digital Content Protection).
HDCP is a copy protection technology consisting of data
encoding and mutual identification of the devices.
The AVR-2808CI is HDCP-compatible. For details on the
DVD player or monitor you are using, refer to its operating
instructions.
When the AVR-2808CI and DVD player are connected using an HDMI cable, also connect the AVR-2808CI
and monitor using an HDMI cable.
If the connected monitor or DVD player only has a DVI-D connector, use an HDMI/DVI converter cable.
When using a DVI cable, no audio signals are transmitted.
Use a Deep Color compatible cable for connection to Deep Color compatible devices.
When connecting with an HDMI/DVI converter cable (adapter)
HDMI video signals are theoretically compatible with the DVI format.
When connecting to a monitor, etc., equipped with a DVI-D connector, connection is possible using an
HDMI/DVI converter cable, but depending on the combination of components in some cases the video
signals will not be output.
When connecting using an HDMI/DVI converter adapter, the video signals may not be output properly
due to poor connections with the connected cable, etc.
By default, the HDMI audio signals are output from the speakers connected to the AVR-2808CI.
To output the sound from the TV, make the settings at menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI
Audio Setup” – “TV” (vpage 27).
NOTE
Use a CPPM-compatible DVD player to play DVD-Audio discs that are copyright-protected by CPPM.
The AVR-2808CI cannot be controlled from another device via the HDMI cable.
The audio signals output from the HDMI connector (sampling frequency, bit rate, etc.) may be restricted
by the connected device.
Video signals are not output properly when using devices that are not HDCP-compatible.
Video signals are not output if the input video signals do not match the monitor’s resolution. In this case,
switch the DVD player’s resolution to a resolution with which the monitor is compatible.
If the menu “Manual Setup” “HDMI Setup” “HDMI Audio Setup” setting (vpage 27) is set to
AMP”, the sound may be interrupted when the monitor’s power is turned off.
Use a cable on which the HDMI logo is indicated (a certified HDMI product) for connection to the HDMI
connector. Normal playback may not be possible when using a cable other than one on which the HDMI
logo is indicated (a non-HDMI-certified product).
If the monitor or DVD player does not support deep color, deep color signal transfer is not possible.
If the monitor or DVD player does not support xvYCC, xvYCC signal transfer is not possible.
If the monitor does not support “Auto Lipsync Correction” function, this function will not work.
Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors
AVR2808CIEU.indd 14 2007/06/20 8:57:00

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Connect the cables to be used (vpage 8 “Video Conversion Function”).
With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
To output the audio signals to the monitor with HDMI connections, set menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI
Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” to “TV” (vpage 27).
Connecting the Monitor
47*%&0
*/
7*%&0
$0.10/&/57*%&0
: 1# 13
7*%&0
*/
)%.*
*/ */
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
$0.10/&/57*%&0
: 1# 13
7*%&0
065 065
"6%*0
$0"9*"-
065
3-
065065
)%.*
Monitor
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect
correctly.
Connecting the Playback Components
DVD Player
Connect the cables to be used.
With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable.
DVD player
NOTE
The component video connectors may be indicated differently on your monitor. For details, see the
monitor’s operating instructions.
The audio signals output from the HDMI connectors are only the HDMI input signals.
Video-converted HDMI signals are not included in the audio signals. To play the sound by monitor, make
analog or digital audio output connections to monitors audio input connectors.
Connect an HDP (High-Definition Player) in the same way.
When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
AVR2808CIEU.indd 15 2007/06/20 8:57:05
Record Player
When connecting a record player with an MC cartridge, use a
commercially available MC head amplifier or a step-up transformer.
Induction humming (a booming sound) may be produced from the
speakers if the volume is raised with no record player connected.
With some record players, noise may be generated when the ground
wire is connected. If so, disconnect the ground wire.
(/%
"6%*0
065
R
L
Turntable (MM cartridge)
NOTE
The AVR-2808CI’s SIGNAL GND terminal is meant to reduce noise
when a record player is connected. This is not a safety ground
terminal.
R
L
R
L
"6%*0
"6%*0
$0"9*"-
065
3-
065
CD Player
Connect the cables to be used.
CD player
When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make
the settings at menu “Input Setup” – Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage
35).
ConnectionsGetting Started Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 16 2007/06/20 8:57:08

47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
$0.10/&/57*%&0
: 1# 13
7*%&0
065 065
"6%*0
3-
065
$0"9*"-
065
R
L
R
L
TV/CABLE Tuner
Connect the cables to be used.
TV tuner
When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
iPod
®
Example 1:
R
L
R
L
"4%3
iPod
With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector.
To assign the iPod to a connector other than VCR (iPod), make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
“(input source to which iPod dock assigned)” – Assign” – “iPod dock” (vpage 36).
Use a DENON Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R, ASD-3N or ASD-3W, sold separately) to connect the iPod to
the AVR-2808CI. For instructions on the Control Dock for iPod settings, refer to the Control Dock for iPod’s
operating instructions.
Example 2:
R
L
R
L
"4%/8
iPod
AVR2808CIEU.indd 17 2007/06/20 8:57:13
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect
correctly.
Connecting the Recording Components
Digital Video Recorder
Connect the cables to be used.
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
*/
3- 3-
*/*/065
"6%*07*%&0
*/065
015*$"-
065
"6%*07*%&0
065
Digital video recorder
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808CI’s OPTICAL2 output connector
to any input connector other than OPTICAL2.
Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals.
When recording via the AVR-2808CI, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable
used to connect the AVR-2808CI´s DVR OUT connector.
Example: TV IN S-Video cable : DVR OUT S-Video cable
TV IN Video cable : DVR OUT Video cable
When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 36).
or or

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Satellite Receiver
Connect the cables to be used.
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
7*%&0
065 065
015*$"-"6%*0
3-
065
DBS / BS tuner
When using a coaxial digital cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input
Setup” – Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35).
When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 36).
AVR2808CIEU.indd 18 2007/06/20 8:57:19
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
3- 3-
065 */065
015*$"-
*/
"6%*0
"6%*0
CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck
Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals, or digital connections if you wish to
record digital audio signals, depending on the types of connectors on the components being used.
CD recorder /
MD recorder / Tape deck
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808CI’s OPTICAL3 output connector
to any input connector other than OPTICAL3.
or

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
*/
3- 3-
*/*/065
"6%*07*%&0
*/065
015*$"-
065
"6%*07*%&0
065
Video Cassette Recorder
Connect the cables to be used.
Video cassette recorder
When recording via the AVR-2808CI, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable
used to connect the AVR-2808CI´s VCR OUT connector.
Example: TV IN S-Video cable : VCR OUT S-Video cable
TV IN Video cable : VCR OUT Video cable
When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup”
Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 36).
or
NOTE
Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808CI’s OPTICAL3 output connector
to any input connector other than OPTICAL3.
or
AVR2808CIEU.indd 19 2007/06/20 8:57:24

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
R
L
R
L
47*%&0
065
"6%*07*%&0
7*%&0
065 065
015*$"-"6%*0
3-
065
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
46#
800'&3
$&/5&3 463306/%
#"$,
3-
463306/%
3-
'30/5
3-
"6%*0
Video Camera / Game Console
Video camera / Game console
Component with Multi-channel Output
connectors
DVD player /
Super Audio CD player / External decoder
To play the analog input signals input to the EXT. IN connectors, press
the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or INPUT button on the
main remote control unit and select “EXT. IN” or make the settings
at menu “Input Setup” – “Input Mode– “Input Mode“EXT. IN”
(vpage 34).
The video signal can be connected in the same way as a DVD player
(vpage 12).
To play copyright-protected discs, connect the AVR-2808CI’s EXT.
IN connector with the DVD player’s analog multi-channel output
connector.
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
R
L
46#
800'&3
$&/5&3 463306/%
#"$,
3-
463306/%
3-
'30/5
3-
"6%*0
External Power Amplifier
When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left
channel (SBL).
Power amplifier
Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and
outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly.
Connections to Other Devices
AVR2808CIEU.indd 20 2007/06/20 8:57:29
XM
NOTE
Keep the power cord unplugged until the XM Mini-Tuner and Home
Dock connection have been completed.
XM connector
The AVR-2808CI is an XM Ready
®
receiver. You can receive XM
®
Satellite Radio by connecting to the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock
(includes home antenna, sold separately) and subscribing to the XM
service.
Plug the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock into the XM connector on
the rear panel.
Position the Home Dock antenna near a south-facing window to
receive the best signal.
For details, see “Listening to XM Satellite Radio Programs” (vpage
45, 46).
When making connections, also refer to the operating instructions of
the XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock.
XM Mini-Tuner and Home Dock
The XM name and related logo are registered trademarks of XM
Satellite Radio Inc. All rights reserved.
XM Ready is a registered trademark of XM Satellite Radio Inc. All
rights reserved.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Antenna terminals
An F-type FM antenna cable plug can be connected directly.
Direction of broadcasting station
AM loop antenna
(supplied)
FM antenna
75 Ω/ohms
Coaxial cable
FM indoor antenna
(supplied)
Ground
AM outdoor antenna
Note to CATV system installer:
This reminder is provided to call the CATV system
installers attention to Article 820-40 of the NEC
which provides guidelines for proper grounding and,
in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be
connected to the grounding system of the building,
as close to the point of cable entry as practical.
AM loop antenna assembly
Remove the vinyl tie and take
out the connection line.
Connect to the AM
antenna terminals.
Bend in the reverse direction.
a. With the antenna on top of
any stable surface.
Mount
b. With the antenna attached
to a wall.
Installation hole Mount on wall, etc.
Connection of AM antennas
1. Push the
lever.
2. Insert the
conductor.
3. Return the
lever.
NOTE
Do not connect two FM antennas simultaneously.
Even if an external AM antenna is used, do not
disconnect the AM loop antenna.
Make sure the AM loop antenna lead terminals do not
touch metal parts of the panel.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 21 2007/06/20 8:57:33
Multi-zone
ZONE2 or ZONE3 Pre-out Connections
If another power amplifier or pre-main (integrated) amplifier is connected, the ZONE2 or ZONE3 pre-out
(variable or fixed level) connectors can be used to play a different program source in ZONE2 or ZONE3
the same time (vpage 57 ~ 60).
When using an S-Video cable or a video cable for connection between the AVR-2808CI and an input
device, connect to the video connectors.
The ZONE2 video out is only for ZONE2.
R
L
R
L
"6%*0
3-
*/*/
7*%&0
"6%*07*%&0
"69
065
Monitor (ZONE2)
Power amplier
(ZONE2 or ZONE3)
Input
Output
Infrared
retransmitter
Infrared
sensor
Extension jack for future use.
NOTE
For the audio output, use high quality pin-plug cords so that no induction humming or noise is produced.
For instructions on installing and operating separately sold devices, refer to the respective devices
operating instructions.
To conduct multi-zone playback, see Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations” (vpage 57
~ 60).

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
External Controller
When using in combination with an RF Remote Controller (RC-7000CI, sold separately) or RF Remote
Receiver (RC-7001RCI, sold separately) two-way communication with an RF Remote Controller is
possible.
The AVR-2808CI’s status information as well as iPod can be browsed watching the RF Remote Controller’s
display. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the respective devices.
When used in combination with an RF Remote Controller or RF Remote Receiver, make the settings at
menu “Manual Setup” – Option Setup” – “2Way Remote” – “Used” (vpage 32).
RS-232C connector
This connector is used for an external controller.
b If you wish to control the AVR-2808CI from
an external controller using the RS-232C
connector, perform the operation below
beforehand.
q Turn om the AVR-2808CI’s power.
w Turn off the AVR-2808CI’s power from the
external controller.
e Check that the AVR-2808CI is in the standby
mode.
Trigger output jacks
The power of an external device equipped with
a trigger input jack can be turned on and off in
association with operations on the AVR-2808CI.
For details, see menu “Manual Setup” – “Option
Setup” – “Trigger Out” (vpage 32).
Output: DC 12 V 150 mA MAX.
Check the trigger input conditions of the
connected device.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 22 2007/06/20 8:57:37
NOTE
Insert the AC plugs securely. Incomplete connections could cause noise.
Only use the AC outlets to plug in audio devices. Do not use them as power supplies for hairdryers or
anything other than audio equipment.
Wait until all connections have been completed before connecting the power cord.
To household
power outlet
(AC 120 V, 60 Hz)
Power cord
(included)
Connection to the AC outlets
These outlets supply power to external audio
devices.
The power supplied from these outlets turns on and
off together with the set’s power switch.
Audio equipment with a total power consumption
of 120 W (1 A) can be connected.
Connecting the Power Cord
Turning the Power On (vpage 43)
Once Connections are Completed
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
MENU
uiop
ENTER
RETURN
[ AMP]
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control
unit
ENTER RETURN
uiop
MENU
1
Press MENU.
The menu is displayed.
b To operate from the main remote control unit,
be sure to set the remote control unit to the
AMP mode.
2
Press ui to select the item you want
to set, then press ENTER.
3
Press ui again to select the item you
want to set, then press ENTER.
4
To change the setting:
Press ui to select the item you want
to change, then press o p to change
the setting.
b To return to the previous item, press RETURN.
b Select “Default Yes”, then press o to reset to
the default setting.
5
Press ENTER to enter the setting.
6
Press MENU to nish.
Menu Operations
With the AVR-2808CI, settings and operations for most functions can be performed by operating while
looking at the menus displayed on the monitor screen.
Operations
The same operation is possible on the main unit
or remote control unit.
When MENU is pressed, the settings made up
to that point are entered and the setting menu is
cleared.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 23 2007/06/20 8:57:39

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display
MENU
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
GOn-screen displayHGFront displayH
* M E N U
A u t o S e tu p
Q
* S t a r t Me n u
S t a r t
QQ
* D i s t a n ce
E
U n i t : M e te r F e e t
WQ
[Selectable items]
A
B
A + B
Example of Display of Default
Values
In lists of selectable items or adjustable ranges, the item
surrounded by a border is the default value.
1-1.Start Menu
Step1:Speaker Detection
at ear height at
Front Sp. A
Amp Assign
Start
Cancel
Please place microphone
main listening position.
3-1.Assign
Digital In : OPT1
iPod Dock : None
2-1-3.Distance
Set The Distance To
Meters : Feet
Each Speakers
Do You Prefer
In Meters? / In Feet?
* A s s i g n
D i g i t a l : O P T 1
EQ
Screen title
Menu number
Submenu title
Press o to execute
Press op to change the setting
Current setting
Currently selected line
Press op to select one or the other
Some typical examples are described below.
* R e n a m e :D V D
R e n a m e C l e a r
Default
: DV
3-3.Rename
Yes
DVD
Default
: DVD-3930
3-3.Rename
Yes
DVD
* R e n a m e :D V D
D V ¡
Use op to change the character input
position.
Use ui to input characters.
When highlighted, press i to select
“Default Yes”.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 24 2007/06/20 8:57:41

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Menu Map
MENU
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
Auto Setup
(vpage 23 ~ 25)
n Start Menu
Step 1: Speaker Detection
Step 2: Measurements
Step 3: Calculation
Step 4: Check
Step 5: Store
n Option
Room EQ
Direct Mode Setup
Mic Select
n Parameter Check
Speaker Confi guration Check
Distance Check
Channel Level Check
Crossover Frequency Check
EQ Check
Restore
Manual Setup
(vpage 26 ~ 33)
n Speaker Setup (vpage 26, 27)
Speaker Confi guration
Subwoofer Setup
Distance
Channel Level
Crossover Frequency
n HDMI Setup (vpage 27, 28)
HDMI Audio Setup
· HDMI Audio Out
· Auto Lipsync
HDMI Video Setup
· i/p Scaler
· Resolution
· Progressive Mode
· Aspect
· Color Space
· RGB Range
n Audio Setup (vpage 28, 29)
EXT. IN Subwoofer Level
2ch Direct/Stereo
Dolby Digital Setup
Auto Surround Mode
Manual EQ
n Zone Setup (vpage 30)
ZONE2 Setup
· Bass
· Treble
· HPF
· Level Lch
· Level Rch
· Channel
· Volume Level
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
ZONE3 Setup
· Bass
· Treble
· HPF
· Level Lch
· Level Rch
· Channel
· Volume Level
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
n Option Setup (vpage 31 ~ 33)
Amp Assign
Volume Control
· Volume Limit
· Power On Level
· Mute Level
Source Delete
On-Screen Display
· Screensaver
· Text
· Master Volume
· Tuner Information
· iPod Information
· Display Mode
Quick Select Name
Trigger Out
Remote ID Setup
2Way Remote
Display
Setup Lock
Parameter
(vpage 38 ~ 41)
n Surround Parameter
MODE
CINEMA EQ
D.COMP
DRC
LFE
CENTER IMAGE
PANORAMA
DIMENSION
CENTER WIDTH
DELAY TIME
EFFECT
LEVEL
ROOM SIZE
AFDM
SB CH OUT
SUBWOOFER ATT.
Subwoofer
Default
n Tone Control
Tone Defeat
Bass
Treble
n Room EQ
n RESTORER
n Night Mode
n Audio Delay
Information
(vpage 41, 42)
n Status
MAIN ZONE
ZONE2/3
n Audio Input Signal
n HDMI Information
n Auto Surround Mode
n Quick Select
n Preset Station
Input Setup
(vpage 33 ~ 36)
n TUNER (FM/AM)
Auto Preset
Preset Skip
Preset Name
Input Mode
Rename
Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
n PHONO
Input Mode
Rename
Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
n CD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL,
SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX
Assign
Input Mode
Rename
Other
· Video Select
· Video Convert (Excluding CDs)
· Source Level
iPod
n XM
Preset Skip
Antenna Aiming
Input Mode
Rename
Other
· Video Select
· Source Level
NOTE
When “Screensaver” is set to
ON”, the screensaver is activated
if no operation is performed for
about 3 minutes.
When the uiop, ENTER or
MENU button is pressed, the
screensaver is canceled and
the corresponding operation is
performed.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 25 2007/06/20 8:57:57
This procedure lets you measure the acoustic properties of your
speakers and listening room and make the optimum settings
automatically.
This function provides the optimum listening environment for all
listening positions in a home theater where several people view or
listen to the video or audio source simultaneously.
The measurements are performed by moving the setup microphone
successively to the different positions where the family members
sit within the listening area surrounded by the speakers, as
shown in Example q. For better results, we recommend making
measurements in 6 or more positions.
Even if the home theater is only used by a small number of persons
as shown in Example w, measuring at points around the listening
position results in more effective correction.
Preparations
When using a subwoofer with a setting function, make the following
settings before starting the auto setup procedure:
Volume: “Center”
Crossover frequency: “Maximum”
Low pass filter: Off
Standby mode: Off
NOTE
Do not disconnect the setup microphone until the auto setup
procedure is completed.
When using headphones, unplug the headphones before starting
the auto setup procedure.
Auto Setup
To set the listening environment manually to suit your tastes, see page
26, 27.
1
Connect the included setup microphone to the SETUP
MIC jack on the main unit.
The auto setup screen appears automatically.
2
Mount the setup microphone on a camera tripod,
etc., and set it at the main listening position, with the
sound receptor pointing towards the ceiling.
b Adjust the height of the setup microphone’s sound receptor so
that it is at the height of the ears when listening.
Sound
receptor
Setup
microphone
About the main listening position (*M)
The main listening position refers to the center of the listening
position, or the place where you would sit to watch or listen when
alone.
This position is used as the basis when measuring the distance of
the speakers.
*
M
*
M
Example q Example w
( :Measuring positions)

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 26 2007/06/20 8:57:58
The speaker connection status and the speaker polarities are detected at
the main listening position. At this time, the listening environment with
respect to the main listening position (“Speaker size check”, “Distance
correction, “Channel level adjustment”, “Crossover frequency check”
and “Room EQ correction”) is measured automatically at the main
listening position.
Once the measurements are completed, the results of the speaker
connection are displayed.
Step 1 : Speaker Detection
Auto Setup
Optimize settings for speakers in use.
F Menu screen F
1-1.Start Menu
Step1:Speaker Detection
at ear height at
Front Sp. A
Amp Assign
Start
Cancel
Please place microphone
main listening position.
Start
Start auto setup and output the test tone.
NOTE
Loud test tones are output during the measurements. Be careful
when measuring at night or when there are small children nearby.
Do not stand between the speakers and setup microphone or allow
obstacles between them while the measurements are being made.
Obstacles will make it impossible to measure correctly.
Keep as quiet as possible during measurements. Loud sounds in the
area will make it impossible to measure correctly.
Operating the MASTER VOLUME knob on the main unit or the VOL
+/– buttons on the remote control unit during the measurements will
cancel the measurements.
Do not change the speaker connections or subwoofer volume after
“Step 1”.
a Start Menu
The settings are performed automatically.
NOTE
Do not turn the power off while the settings are being stored in the
memory.
Step 2 : Measurements
The listening environment with respect to the listening position
(“Speaker size check”, “Crossover Frequency check” and “Room EQ
correction”) is measured automatically at positions 2 to 8.
Once a measurement is made, move the setup microphone to the
next position.
Measure a total of at least 6 positions (main listening position and at
least 5 other surrounding positions). Measurements can be completed
even if only taken in 5 positions, but for better results we recommend
taking them in 6 or more positions. (Measurements can be taken in
a maximum of 8 positions.)
Step 3 : Calculation
When “Calculate is selected at “Step 2”, the speaker system is
analyzed automatically.
The time required for this analysis depends on the number of speakers
connected. The more the number of speakers, the longer the time
required for analysis.
Step 4 : Check
Once the auto setup procedure is completed, a measuring result
checking screen appears.
Select any item whose measuring results you want to check and check
the results.
Values that are different from the actual distance may be set for
speakers with built-in fi lters (subwoofers, etc.).
Step 5 : Store
The auto setup measurement results are stored.
Front Speaker
The front speaker to be measured can be selected ahead of time
here.
[Selectable items]
A
: Output test tone from front speakers A.
B
: Output test tone from front speakers B.
A + B
: Output test tone from front speakers A and B.
Amp Assign
Advanced setting : changes power amplifi er assignment.
For details, refer to Amp Assign” (vpage 31).
If an error message appears during the measurements, check “Error
messages”, take the necessary countermeasures, then redo the
measurements (vpage 25).

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Set as desired before starting the auto setup procedure.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 27 2007/06/20 8:58:01
Error Messages
If the auto setup procedure could not be completed due to speaker installation, the measuring environment, etc., an error message is
displayed. If this happens, check the relevant items, be sure to take the necessary measures, then perform the auto setup procedure over
again.
Error messages (examples) Cause Measures
or
Retry
Cancel
Microphone:None
Speaker :None
Auto Setup
Caution!
Included setup microphone is not connected.
Not all speakers could be detected.
Connect the included setup microphone to the SETUP
MIC jack on the main unit.
Check the speaker connections.
too high or
Retry
Cancel
Ambient noise is
Level is too low.
Auto Setup
Caution!
Too much noise in the room for accurate
measurements to be made.
Speaker or subwoofer sound is too low for
accurate measurements to be made.
Either turn off any device generating noise or move it
away.
Try again when the surroundings are quiet.
Check the speaker installation and the direction in
which the speakers are facing.
Adjust the subwoofer’s volume.
Retry
L :None
Cancel
Skip
Front
Auto Setup
Caution!
Displayed speaker could not be detected.
· The front L and front R speakers were not
properly detected.
· Only one channel of the surround speakers
was detected.
· Sound was output from the R channel
when only one surround back speaker was
connected.
· The surround back, but the surround speaker
was not detected.
Check the connections of the displayed speaker.
Retry
L :Phase
Cancel
Skip
Front
Auto Setup
Caution!
Displayed speaker connected with the
polarities reversed.
Check the polarities of the displayed speaker.
For some speakers, this error message may be
displayed even if the speaker is properly connected. In
this case, select “Skip”.
NOTE
Be sure to turn the power off before checking the speaker connections.
Room EQ
Select room EQ setting method.
[Selectable items]
All
: Apply settings to all surround modes.
Assign
: Make settings for each surround mode separately.
s
Option
Select settings for room EQ, mic, etc.
Select “Retry” to make the measurements again.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Direct Mode Setup
Select room EQ use for DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Use room EQ.
OFF
: Do not use room EQ.
Mic Select
Select the microphone type if not using supplied mic.
The microphone connected to V.AUX Lch is used.
[Selectable items]
Mic
: Supplied mic is being used.
V.AUX L
: Other mic connected to V.AUX is used.
d
Parameter Check
Check auto setup measurement results.
This is displayed after the auto setup procedure is completed.
[Items to be checked]
Speaker Config. Check
Distance Check
Channel Level Check
Crossover Freq. Check
EQ Check
The auto setup results can be set again when “Restore” is selected.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 28 2007/06/20 8:58:01
Make detail settings for various parameters.
Speaker Setup
Use this procedure to set the speakers manually or if you wish to
change the settings made with the auto setup procedure.
F Menu screen F
MENU
1.Auto Setup
2.Manual Setup
3.Input Setup
4.Parameter
5.Information
Manual Setup
a
Speaker Configuration
Select speaker configuration and size.
(bass reproduction capability)
s
Subwoofer Setup
Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer.
This can be set when menu “Speaker Configuration” – “Subwoofer”
is set to “Yes”.
Play music or a movie source and select the mode offering the
strongest bass.
Select “LFE+Main if you want the bass signals to always be
produced from the subwoofer.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Select “Largeor “Small” not according to the physical size of the
speaker but according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities
based on the frequency set at “Crossover Frequency” (vpage
27).
When “Front Speaker” is set to “Small”, “Subwoofer” is automatically
set to “Yes”.
If “Subwoofer” is set to “No, “Front Speaker” is automatically set to
“Large.
If “Surround Speaker” is set to “None, “Surround Back Speaker” are
automatically set to “None.
When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left
channel (SBL).
Large
: Select this when using large speakers with ample low
frequency reproduction capabilities.
Small
: Select this when using small speakers without ample low
frequency reproduction capabilities.
None
: Select this when no speaker is connected.
Yes
: Select this when a subwoofer is connected.
No
: Select this when no subwoofer is connected.
2spkrs
1spkr
:
Select the number of surround back speakers.
Front Speaker
Select front speaker size.
[Selectable items]
Large
Small
Subwoofer
Select subwoofer use.
[Selectable items]
Yes
No
Surround Speaker
Select surround speakers use and size.
[Selectable items]
Large
Small
None
Surround Back Speaker
Select surround back speaker use and size.
[Selectable items]
(
Large
Small
None
)
(
2spkrs
1spkr
)
Center Speaker
Select center speaker use and size.
[Selectable items]
Large
Small
None
[Selectable items]
LFE
: Play low range and LFE signal of channels set to
“Small”.
LFE+Main
: Play low range and LFE signal of all channels.
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
d
Distance
Set distance from listening position to speakers.
Before making the settings, measure the distance from the
listening position to the different speakers.
Feet / Meters
Select unit for distance.
Step
Select step. (smallest distance)
[Selectable items]
1ft
0.1ft
: Can be selected when “Feet” is set.
0.1m
0.01m
: Can be selected when “Meters” is set.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
NOTE
By default, the AVR-2808CI’s “Amp Assign” setting is set to “ZONE2”.
To use as the surround back speaker for the main zone, change the
Amp Assign” setting (vpage 31).
AVR2808CIEU.indd 29 2007/06/20 8:58:02
When the menu “Speaker Configuration“Surround Back Speaker”
setting (vpage 26) is set to “1spkr”, the surround back speaker
display is set to “Surround Back Sp.” .
Speakers set to “None” in the “Speaker Configuration” settings are
not displayed.
When “Channel Level” is adjusted, the adjusted values are set for
all the surround modes. To adjust the channel level separately for the
different surround modes, use the operation see page 48.
Distance measurement
Select the speaker you want to set, then set the distance.
Set the value closest to the measured distance.
[Variable range]
0.0ft ~ 60.0ft
: Display when “Feet” is set.
0.00m ~ 18.00m
: Display when “Meters” is set.
Test Tone
Select test tone playback method.
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically switch speaker from which test tone is
output.
Manual
: Manually switch speaker from which test tone is output.
f
Channel Level
Adjust channel levels to obtain equal volume from all speakers.
Operating from the main remote control unit
Adjusting with the main remote control unit using the test tones is
only possible in the Auto” mode and only effective in the STANDARD
mode. The adjusted levels for the different modes are automatically
stored in the memory.
GAdjusting using test tonesH
q Press the TEST button.
Test tones are output from the various speakers.
w Use the o p button to adjust so that the volume is equal for all
speakers.
e When the adjustments are completed, press the TEST button
again.
Test Tone Start
Output test tone.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
NOTE
Set the distance between the listening position and the various
speakers to no more than 20.0 ft (6.00 meters).
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
g
Crossover Frequency
Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low
range signal.
[Selectable items]
40Hz
60Hz
80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
150Hz
200Hz
250Hz
:
Only the portion of the bass sound of the various speakers output
from the subwoofer that has a frequency below the frequency set
here is output.
Set this according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities of the
speakers you are using.
Advanced
:
Set the crossover frequency separately for the different speakers.
The “Crossover Frequency” can be set when there are speakers that
have been set to “Small” at menu “Speaker Configuration” or when
“Subwoofer” is set to “Yes” (vpage 26).
If menu “Subwoofer Setup” (vpage 26) is set to “LFE”, speakers
set to “Small” at “Speaker Configuration” can be set. If set to
“LFE+Main, this can be set regardless of the size of the speaker.
For speakers set to “Small”, sound below the crossover frequency
is cut from the sound output. The cut bass sound is output from the
subwoofer or front speakers.
Always set the crossover frequency to “80 Hz”. When using small
speakers, however, we recommend setting the crossover frequency
to a higher frequency.
HDMI Setup
Make settings for HDMI video/audio output.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
a
HDMI Audio Setup
Select HDMI audio output device.
2.HDMI Video Setup
1.HDMI Audio Setup
2-2.HDMI Setup
HDMI Audio Out
Select test tone playback method.
[Selectable items]
AMP
: Use speakers connected to receiver for audio playback.
TV
: Use speakers of monitor for audio playback.
Auto Lipsync
Automatic compensation for timing shift in audio and video output.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Use automatic compensation.
OFF
: Do not use automatic compensation.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 30 2007/06/20 8:58:03
NOTE
It is not possible to convert “1080i” signals into “720p” format.
It is not possible to convert “720p” signals into “1080i” format.
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than OFF”.
s
HDMI Video Setup
Select HDMI video output device.
i/p Scaler
Make settings for i/p scaler function.
[Selectable items]
A to H
: Use i/p scaler function for analog video signal.
OFF
: Do not use i/p scaler function.
Resolution
Make settings for resolution of HDMI video output signal.
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Detect monitor panel resolution and automatically set
output resolution.
480p/576p
: Output at 480p/576p resolution.
1080i
: Output at 1080i resolution.
720p
: Output at 720p resolution.
1080p
: Output at 1080p resolution.
Progressive Mode
Select optimum progressive mode for video material.
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically detect video material type.
Video1
: Select mode suitable for video playback.
Video2
: Select mode suitable for video and 30-frame film material
playback.
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than OFF”.
Color Space
Make settings for output color space.
[Selectable items]
YCbCr
: Output using YCbCr format.
RGB
: Output using RGB format.
When connected to a monitor with a DVI-D connector (HDCP
compatible) using an HDMI/DVI converter cable, the signals are output
in RGB format, regardless of this setting.
RGB Range
Make settings for RGB output range.
[Selectable items]
Normal
: Use video range from 16 (black) to 235 (white).
Enhanced
: Video range from 0 (black) to 255 (white). Use this setting
to avoid black washout.
Audio Setup
Make settings for audio playback.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
2.2ch Direct/Stereo
3.Dolby Digital Setup
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Manual EQ
1.EXT.IN SW Level
2-3.Audio Setup
a
EXT. IN Subwoofer Level
Set the subwoofer level for playback.
Select according to the player in use.
[Selectable items]
0dB
+5dB
+10dB
:
Select according to the player in use.
+15dB
:
This is the recommended level.
s
2ch Direct/Stereo
Make speaker settings for 2-channel mode playback.
Setting
To change the settings, select “Custom”.
[Selectable items]
Basic
z
: To change the settings, select “Custom”.
Custom
: Make separate settings for 2-channel mode.
z: Use the same settings as in “Speaker Setup”.
Aspect
This sets the aspect ratio when outputting 480i/576i or 480p/576p
input signals from the HDMI output connector.
[Selectable items]
FULL
: Output at 16:9 aspect ratio.
NORMAL
: Output at 4:3 aspect ratio.
This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to anything other than OFF”.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 31 2007/06/20 8:58:04
Subwoofer Mode
Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer.
[Selectable items]
LFE
LFE+Main
: Select subwoofer signal.
Crossover
Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low range
signal.
[Selectable items]
40Hz
60Hz
80Hz
90Hz
100Hz
110Hz
120Hz
150Hz
200Hz
250Hz
: Select crossover frequency.
Distance FL
Set distance from listening position to front left speaker.
[Variable range]
0.0ft ~ 60.0ft
/
0.00m ~ 18.00m
Distance FR
Set distance from listening position to front right speaker.
[Variable range]
0.0ft ~ 60.0ft
/
0.00m ~ 18.00m
d
Dolby Digital Setup
Set dynamic range for downmix playback of Dolby Digital
sources.
Set this to “ON” if the sound from the front speakers seems
distorted.
When not using the center speaker or surround speakers, the
playback sound is down-mixed and output from the front speakers.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Compression is used. Select this if sound from front
speakers is distorted.
OFF
: Do not use compression. This is the recommended setting.
f
Auto Surround Mode
Make setting for memorizing surround mode setting for each input
signal type.
The auto surround mode function lets you store in the memory the
surround mode last used for playing the four types of input signals
listed below.
q Analog and PCM 2-channel signals
w Dolby Digital and DTS 2-channel signals
e Dolby Digital and DTS multi-channel signals
r Multi-channel signals other than Dolby Digital and DTS (PCM,
DSD, etc.)
When playing in the PURE DIRECT mode, the surround mode does
not change even if the input signal is changed.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Memorize settings. Most recently stored surround mode is
automatically selected.
OFF
: Do not memorize settings. Surround mode does not change
according to input signal.
Front
Select front speaker size.
[Selectable items]
Large
Small
: Select front speaker size.
Subwoofer
Select subwoofer use.
[Selectable items]
Yes
No
: Select subwoofer use.
g
Manual EQ
Adjust tonal quality for each speaker using graphic equalizer.
Base Curve Copy
Copy the ROOM EQ´s “Flat” correction curve and adjust manually.
[Selectable items]
Yes
: Adjust manually.
No
: Do not adjust manually.
“Base Curve Copy” is displayed after the auto setup procedure has
been performed.
Adjust CH
Select speaker adjustment method.
[Selectable items]
Each CH
: Adjust tonal quality for each speaker separately.
L/R CH
: Adjust tonal quality for each L/R speaker pair.
ALL CH
: Adjust tonal quality for all speakers together.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
Manual EQ
Select the speaker and frequency band and adjust the level.
[Selectable items]
63Hz
125Hz
250Hz
500Hz
1kHz
2kHz
4kHz
8kHz
16kHz
[Variable range]
–20dB ~ +6dB

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 32 2007/06/20 8:58:05
Zone Setup
Make settings for audio playback in a multi-zone system.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
a
ZONE2 Setup
Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE2 system.
s
ZONE3 Setup
Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE3 system.
Bass
Adjust low frequency range (bass).
[Variable range]
–10dB
~
0dB
~
+10dB
Treble
Adjust high frequency range (treble).
[Variable range]
–10dB
~
0dB
~
+10dB
HPF
When using speakers that cannot satisfactorily play low frequencies,
distortion of the bass sound can be reduced by setting “HPF” to
ON”.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: The low range is not attenuated.
ON
: The low range is attenuated.
Lch Level
Adjust the left channel output level.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
Rch Level
Adjust the right channel output level.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
Channel
Switch between stereo and mono output.
[Selectable items]
Stereo
: Select stereo output.
Mono
: Select monaural output.
When menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign
(vpage 31) is set to ZONE2/3-MONO, the “Channel” setting is
automatically set to “Mono.
2.ZONE3 Setup
1.ZONE2 Setup
2-4.Zone Setup
Volume Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Do not set a maximum volume.
–20dB
: Set the maximum volume to –20 dB.
–10dB
: Set the maximum volume to –10 dB.
0dB
: Set the maximum volume to 0 dB.
Power On Level
Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on.
[Selectable items]
Last
: Use the memorized setting from the last session.
– – –
: Always use the muting on condition when power
is turned on.
–70dB ~ +18dB
: Set the volume level when the power is turned on
in units of 1 dB.
Mute Level
Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on.
[Selectable items]
Full
: The sound is cut off entirely.
–40dB
: The sound is attenuated by 40 dB.
–20dB
: The sound is attenuated by 20 dB.
Volume Level
Adjust the main volume level.
[Selectable items]
VAR
: Allow volume adjustment by remote control.
–40dB
: Fix the volume to –40 dB.
0dB
: Fix the volume to 0 dB.
“VAR” is displayed when a power amplifier is assigned to the ZONE2
output channel at menu “Manual Setup” Option Setup” Amp
Assign” (vpage 31).
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 33 2007/06/20 8:58:05
Option Setup
Make various other settings.
F Menu screen F
2.Manual Setup
2.HDMI Setup
1.Speaker Setup
4.Zone Setup
5.Option Setup
3.Audio Setup
a
Amp Assign
Define how the amplifier for the surround back speaker channels
is used.
The places where the surround back amplifier are used can be set
freely according to the usage environment. This makes it possible to
output sound to rooms other than the room (the main zone) where
surround playback is performed (multi-zone playback) or play the sound
with high quality using the front speakers (bi-amp connections).
[Selectable items]
7.1ch
ZONE2
ZONE3
ZONE2/3-MONO
FrontA Bi-Amp
FrontB Bi-Amp
2ch
For details, see Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations”
(vpage 57 ~ 59).
s
Volume Control
Set the main zone volume setting.
Volume Limit
Make a setting for maximum volume.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Do not set a maximum volume.
–20dB
: Set the maximum volume to –20 dB.
–10dB
: Set the maximum volume to –10 dB.
0dB
: Set the maximum volume to 0 dB.
Power On Level
This sets the volume set when the main zones power is turned on.
[Selectable items]
Last
: Use the memorized setting from the last session.
– – –
: Always use the muting on condition when power
is turned on.
–80dB ~ +18dB
: Set the volume level when the power is turned on
in units of 1 dB.
Mute Level
This sets the amount of attenuation of the volume when the mute
mode is set in the main zone.
[Selectable items]
Full
: The sound is cut off entirely.
–40dB
: The sound is attenuated by 40 dB.
–20dB
: The sound is attenuated by 20 dB.
2.Vol.Control
3.Source Delete
4.On Screen Display
5.Quick Select Name
6.Trigger Out
7.Remote ID Setup
8.2Way Remote
9.Display
10.Setup Lock
1.Amp Assign
2-5.Option Setup
d
Source Delete
Remove input sources that are not used from the display.
f
On-Screen Display
Make on-screen display related settings.
NOTE
Input sources being used in the various zones cannot be deleted.
Input sources set to “Delete” cannot be selected using the SOURCE
SELECT knob on the main unit or SOURCE SELECT button on the remote
control unit.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Use this source.
Delete
: Do not use this source.
Text
Input source and mode display.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Turn display on.
OFF
: Turn display off.
Master Volume
Master volume display during adjustment.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Turn display on.
OFF
: Turn display off.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Screensaver
Make screensaver settings.
Use the screensaver to prevent burn-in on the monitor screen.
When set to ON”, the screensaver is activated if there is no activity
for about 3 minutes.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Activate the screensaver if there is no activity for about 3
minutes.
OFF
: Turn the screensaver function off.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 34 2007/06/20 8:58:06
Tuner Information
This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation
is performed.
[Selectable items]
Always
: Show display continuously.
30sec
: Show display for 30 seconds after operation.
10sec
: Show display for 10 seconds after operation.
OFF
: Turn display off.
Display Mode
Select the on-screen display's display mode.
[Selectable items]
Mode1
: If there is no video signal, flickering of the on-screen display
is not prevented.
Mode2
: Prevents flickering of the on-screen display when there is
no video signal.
Use this mode if the on-screen display does not appear
in the Mode 1, as may happen according to the TV being
used.
g
Quick Select Name
Change the Quick Select name.
Up to 16 characters can be input.
[Input characters]
A ~ Z
a ~ z
0 ~ 9
! “ # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = (space)
h
Trigger Out
Select the conditions to turn on the trigger out with respect to the
zone, input source, surround mode. For details about the trigger
out function, see page 19.
iPod Information
This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation
is performed.
[Selectable items]
Always
: Show display continuously.
30sec
: Show display for 30 seconds after operation.
10sec
: Show display for 10 seconds after operation.
OFF
: Turn display off.
j
Remote ID Setup
Set remote control ID.
Match the ID setting of the remote control unit and the receiver.
When changing the remote ID, also change the AMP, iPod and TU
modes of the main remote control unit at the same time (vpage
54).
k
2Way Remote
Make setting for 2-way remote control unit.
[Selectable items]
1
2
3
4
:
Match the ID setting of the remote control and the receiver.
[Selectable items]
Used
: Use 2-way remote control.
Not Used
: Do not use 2-way remote control.
When using a 2-way remote control unit (RC-7000CI and RC-7001RCI,
sold separately), set this to “Used”.
l
Display
Adjust display brightness of the receiver.
Operating from the main unit
Press the DIMMER button.
Bright Dim
DarkOFF
[Selectable items]
Bright
: Normal display brightness.
Dim
: Reduced display brightness.
Dark
: Very low display brightness.
OFF
: Display is off unless controls are operated.
Setting with Respect to the Zone
When the power of the zone turned on/off, the trigger out turns on.
Associated with the power supply of zones set to ON”.
Setting with Respect to the Input Source
When the input source set to on is selected, the trigger out turns
on.
Associated with respect to the input source for zones set to ON” at
“Setting with Respect to the Zone.
Setting with Respect to the Surround Mode
When the surround mode set to on is selected, the trigger out turns
on.
Associated with respect to surround modes that are set to ON”.
This can be set if the “MAIN ZONE” setting at “Setting with Respect
to the Zone” is set to ON”.
Associated when an input source for which “Setting with Respect to
the Input Source” is set to ON” is selected.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Activate trigger on this mode.
– – –
: Do not activate trigger on this mode.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Select “Trigger Out 1” or “Trigger Out 2” and make the settings below
respectively.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 35 2007/06/20 8:58:07
A0
Setup Lock
Protect settings from inadvertent change.
When “Setup Lock” is set to ON”, the settings listed below can
no longer be changed. Also, “SETUP LOCKED!” is displayed if you
attempt to operate related buttons.
Menu operations
RESTORER
Night Mode
Parameter
Room EQ
Channel Level
Audio Delay
To cancel the setting, press the MENU button to re-display the “Setup
Lock” screen, then change the setting to OFF”.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Turn protection on.
OFF
: Turn protection off.
Input Setup

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Use this procedure to select the input source and make the settings
related to playing input sources.
n TUNER (AM/FM)
This menu is for “TUNER”.
F Menu screen F
2.Preset Skip
3.Preset Name
4.Input Mode
5.Rename
6.Other
1.Auto Setup
3.Input Setup
TUNER
n XM
This menu is for “XM”.
F Menu screen F
1.Preset Skip
2.Antenna Aiming
3.Input Mode
4.Rename
5.Other
3.Input Setup
XM
n PHONO
This menu is for “PHONO.
F Menu screen F
1.Input Mode
2.Rename
3.Other
3.Input Setup
PHONO
Changing the input source within Input Setup
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
3.Input Setup
CD
The input source currently selected in the main zone is not changed
even when the input source within Input Setup is changed.
n CD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL, SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX
This menu is for “CD”, “DVD”, “HDP”, “TV/CBL, “SAT”, “VCR”, “DVR”,
“V.AUX”.
F Menu screen F
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
3.Input Setup
CD
b The menu settings below can be made for these input sources
when “iPod dock” is set to Assign.
1.Assign
2.Input Mode
3.Rename
4.Other
5.iPod
3.Input Setup
VCR
Repeat : OFF
Shuffle : OFF
3-5.iPod
AVR2808CIEU.indd 36 2007/06/20 8:58:08
Auto Preset
Use the auto preset function to program radio stations.
[Input source]
TUNER
[Selectable items]
Start
: Start the auto preset process.
If an FM station cannot be preset automatically, select the desired
station by tuning it in manually, then preset it manually.
Preset Skip
Make settings to skip preset memory numbers during auto
preset.
A ~ G
Select the preset channel(s) you do not want to display.
[Input source]
TUNER
XM
[Selectable items]
ON
: Display this number.
Skip
: Skip this number.
Preset Name
Assign name to a preset memory.
Names containing up to 8 characters can be input.
A1 ~ G8
Select the preset memory number.
[Input source]
TUNER
[Characters that can be input]
A ~ Z
a ~ z
0 ~ 9
! “ # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = (space)
Input Mode
Make input mode and decode mode settings for this source.
The selectable input modes depend on the input source and
Assign” setting (vpage 35).
Input Mode
Set the input mode for this source.
[Input source]
TUNER
PHONO
[Selectable items]
Analog
: Play only signals from analog input.
EXT. IN
: Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
[Input source]
XM
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically detect input signal and perform playback.
EXT. IN
: Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
[Input source]
CD
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Automatically detect input signal and perform playback.
HDMI
: Play only signals from HDMI input.
Digital
: Play only signals from digital input.
Analog
: Play only signals from analog input.
EXT. IN
: Play only signals from EXT. IN input.
When a digital signal is properly input, the or
indicator lights on the display. If the “ indicator does not light,
check the digital input connector assignment and the connections.
The surround mode cannot be set if the input mode is set to “EXT.
IN”.
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
Press the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or the INPUT button on
the main remote control unit.
Auto HDMI Digital
AnalogEXT. IN
z1
z2
z1: This can be selected for input sources for which the menu
Assign” setting is set to “HDMI” (vpage 35).
z2: This can be selected for input sources for which the menu
Assign” setting is set to “Digital” (vpage 35).
Rename
Change the display name for this source.
Names containing up to 8 characters can be input.
[Characters that can be input]
A ~ Z
a ~ z
0 ~ 9
! “ # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = (space)
Decode Mode
Set the decode mode for this source.
[Input source]
CD
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
Auto
: Detect type of digital input signal and decode and play
automatically.
PCM
: Decode and play only PCM input signals.
DTS
: Decode and play only DTS input signals.
This can be selected for input sources for which the menu “Assign
setting is set to “HDMI” or “Digital” (vpage 35).
Only set “PCM” and “DTS” when playing the respective signals.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Settings Related to Playing Input
Sources
AVR2808CIEU.indd 37 2007/06/20 8:58:09
With HDMI, the video and audio signals are transferred
simultaneously. When HDMI is assigned to an input source, the
audio signal switches to HDMI along with the video signal. To use
with the digital audio input connectors assigned, set menu “Input
Mode” to “Digital” (vpage 34).
When the AVR-2808CI and monitor are connected with an HDMI
cable, if the monitor is not compatible with HDMI audio signal
playback, only the video signals are output to the monitor.
The audio signals input from the analog, digital and EXT. IN connectors
are not output to the monitor.
NOTE
This cannot be set for input sources for which “iPod dock” is
assigned.
Assign
Assign input sources to input connectors.
HDMI
Select HDMI connector to assign to this source.
[Input source]
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
1
: Assign HDMI 1 input connector.
2
: Assign HDMI 2 input connector.
None
: No HDMI input connector assigned.
Input
source
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX
Default
setting
HDMI1 HDMI2 None None None None None
Digital In
Select digital input connector to assign to this source.
[Input source]
CD
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
Coaxial1
: Assign COAXIAL 1 input connector.
Coaxial2
: Assign COAXIAL 2 input connector.
Coaxial3
: Assign COAXIAL 3 input connector.
Optical1
: Assign OPTICAL 1 input connector.
Optical2
: Assign OPTICAL 2 input connector.
Optical3
: Assign OPTICAL 3 input connector.
Optical4
: Assign OPTICAL 4 input connector.
None
: No digital input connector assigned.
NOTE
This cannot be set for input sources for which “iPod dock” is
assigned.
Input
source
CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX
Default
setting
Coaxial
3
Coaxial
1
None
Coaxial
2
Optical
1
Optical
3
Optical
2
Optical
4

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
This cannot be set for input sources for which “iPod dock” is assigned.
Input
source
DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX
Default
setting
Component
1
Component
2
Component
3
None None None None
Component In
Select component video input to assign to this source.
[Input source]
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
1
: Assign component video 1 input connector.
2
: Assign component video 2 input connector.
3
: Assign component video 3 input connector.
None
: No component video input connector assigned.
iPod dock
Assign Control Dock for iPod to this source.
[Input source]
CD
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
Assign
: Assign iPod input.
None
: Do not assign iPod input.
With the default settings, the Control Dock for iPod can be used
connected to the VCR (iPod) connector.
Even if “iPod dock” is set to Assign, if the AVR-2808CI is not
connected to a Control Dock for iPod, the input source can be used
as the normal input source.
iPod
Make settings for “iPod” playback.
Repeat
Make settings for repeat mode.
[Selectable items]
All
: Repeat all songs.
One
: Repeat the current song.
OFF
: Cancel repeat mode.
[Input source]
CD
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
AVR2808CIEU.indd 38 2007/06/20 8:58:10
Antenna Aiming
Adjust the XM radio reception sensitivity.
Satellite
Indicate satellite signal strength.
Terrestrial
Indicate terrestrial signal strength.
[Input source]
XM
DTS NEO:6
: The signals are decoded in DTS NEO:6 for
playback.
Cinema
: This mode is suited for movie sources.
Music
: This mode is suited for music sources.
neural
: It is possible to play analog input signals and
PCM (2-channel, 48 kHz or less) in the surround
mode.
This is the optimum mode for playing sources
recorded in XM HD Surround (vpage 63).
Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources
DOLBY PLgx
or DOLBY PLg
:
The signals are decoded in DOLBY PLgx or
DOLBY PLg for playback.
Cinema
: This mode is suited for movie sources.
Music
: This mode is suited for music sources.
Game
: This mode is suited for games.
Pro Logic
: This is the Pro Logic playback mode. This can
be selected when playing with a DOLBY PLg
decoder. When this mode is selected, “DOLBY
PL” is displayed.
Standard Playback
This is the standard mode for enjoying surround sound according
to the program source.
Surround Modes
To select these surround modes using the buttons on the main unit
and main remote control unit, press the STANDARD button. The mode
switches each time the button is pressed.
n When using a surround back speaker
[Selectable items]
DOLBY PLgx
DTS NEO:6
neural
n When not using a surround back speaker
[Selectable items]
DOLBY PLg
DTS NEO:6
neural

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Source Level
Corrects the playback level of the selected input sources audio input.
[Variable range]
–12dB
~
0dB
~
+12dB
For input sources for which “HDMI” and “Digital” are set at the menu
Assignsetting, the analog input level and digital input level can be
set separately.
Other
Make various other settings.
Video Select
Switch video input source while listening to audio signal.
[Selectable items]
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
:
Select video input source to view.
Source
:
The video and audio for the same input source are played.
Operating from the main unit
Press the VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the SOURCE SELECT knob until
the desired picture appears.
b To cancel, press the main unit’s VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the
main unit’s SOURCE SELECT knob and select “Source.
NOTE
It is not possible to select HDMI input signals.
When playing HDMI video input signals, the analog video signal of
another input source cannot be selected for the HDMI video output.
Input sources for which “Delete is selected at “Source Delete
cannot be selected.
Video Convert
Automatically convert video input signal to monitor output format.
[Input source]
DVD
HDP
TV/CBL
SAT
VCR
DVR
V.AUX
[Selectable items]
ON
: Enable conversion.
OFF
: Disable conversion.
Shuffle
Make settings for shufe mode.
[Selectable items]
Songs
: Shufe all songs.
Albums
: Shufe songs from current album only.
OFF
: Cancel shufe mode.
This can be selected for input sources for which “Assignis assigned
at the “iPod dock” setting.
Display Condition
Signal strength is strong
Signal strength is good
Signal strength is marginal
Signal strength is weak
No signal
AVR2808CIEU.indd 39 2007/06/20 8:58:11
Select the “Cinema”, “Music”, “Gameand “Pro Logic” modes at menu
“Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” (vpage 38).
Input signal Display
Dolby
Digital
Source
DOLBY DIGITAL
(other than 2ch) /
DOLBY DIGITAL
EX
DOLBY DIGITAL
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx CINEMA
DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx MUSIC
DOLBY DIGITAL
Plus
DOLBY DIGITAL +
DOLBY TrueHD DOLBY TrueHD
DTS
Surround
Source
DTS (5.1ch) /
DTS-ES Discrete
6.1 /
DTS-ES Matrix
6.1 /
DTS 96/24
DTS SURROUND
DTS+PLgx CINEMA
DTS+PLgx MUSIC
DTS+NEO:6
DTS ES MTRX6.1 (z1)
DTS ES DSCRT6.1 (z2)
DTS 96/24 (z3)
DTS-HD High
Resolution Audio
DTS-HD
DTS-HD Master
Audio
DTS-HD MSTR
DVD-
Audio,
SACD
PCM (multi ch) /
DSD (multi ch)
MULTI CH IN
MULTI IN+PLgx CINEMA
MULTI IN+PLgx MUSIC
MULTI CH IN 7.1
z1 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Matrix 6.1”
and the AVR-2808CI’s AFDM” setting is set to ON”.
z2 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Discrete
6.1”.
z3 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS 96/24”.
For details, see page 66.
Playing Multi-channel Sources
(Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.)
[Selectable items]
STANDARD
:
This mode is for decoding the input signals according to their format
and playing surround sound.
The display when the STANDARD mode is selected depends on the
input signal and surround back output playback mode.
To select these surround modes using the buttons on the main
remote control unit, press the SIMU button. The mode switches each
time the button is pressed.
Depending on the program source being played, it may not be
possible to achieve a satisfactory surround effect. In this case, try
other modes to achieve a sound field suited to your tastes.
DSP Simulation Playback
The desired mode according to the program source and viewing
situation can be selected from among 10 DENON original surround
modes.
The surround parameters can be adjusted (vpage 64, 65) to
achieve an even more realistic, powerful sound field.
[Selectable items]
7CH STEREO
: This mode is for enjoying stereo sound from
all speakers.
WIDE SCREEN
: This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of
viewing a movie on a large screen.
SUPER STADIUM
: This mode is suited for viewing sports
programs.
ROCK ARENA
: This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a
live concert in an arena.
JAZZ CLUB
: This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a
live concert in a jazz club.
CLASSIC CONCERT
: This mode is for appreciating classical concert
programs.
MONO MOVIE
z
: This mode is for playing monaural movie
sources with surround sound.
VIDEO GAME
: This mode is suited for achieving surround
sound with video games.
MATRIX
: This mode lets you add a sense of expansion
to stereo music sources.
VIRTUAL
: This mode is for enjoying surround effects
using only the front speakers or headphones.
z: When playing sources recorded in monaural in the MONO MOVIE
mode, the sound will be off balance with a single channel (left or
right), so input to both channels.
Input signal
Display
Analog signal /
PCM (2ch) /
Dolby Digital source /
DTS source /
Other 2-channel digital signals
DIRECT
DSD (2ch) DSD DIRECT (
z
)
PCM (multi ch)
MULTI CH DIRECT
M DIRECT + PL
g
x CINEMA
M DIRECT + PL
g
x MUSIC
M DIRECT 7.1
DSD (multi ch) DSD MULTI DIRECT (
z
)
z : When DSD signals are converted to PCM signals as set by the
audio parameters and speaker settings, “DIRECT” or “MULTI CH
DIRECT” is displayed.
For details, see page 67.
Direct Playback
[Selectable items]
DIRECT
:
In this mode the signals bypass the tone adjustment circuitry for high
quality sound.
The sound is output to the same channels as the input signal.
The display when the DIRECT mode is selected depends on the input
signal.
For multi-channel sources, the display depends on the surround back
output’s play mode.
Stereo Playback
[Selectable items]
STEREO
:
This is the mode for playing in stereo. The tone can be adjusted.
Sound is output from the front left and right speakers and subwoofer.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 40 2007/06/20 8:58:12
Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode
This is the mode that recreates the original sound most faithfully,
providing extremely high quality sound.
When in the PURE DIRECT mode, the menu screen is not displayed
and the display on the main unit is turned off.
If the HDMI input connector is selected, video outputs are output in
the PURE DIRECT mode.
The channel level and surround parameters in the PURE DIRECT
mode are the same as in the DIRECT mode.
Press the PURE DIRECT button on the main unit.
F Menu screen F
2.Tone Control
3.Room EQ
4.RESTORER
5.Night Mode
6.Audio Delay
1.Surround Parameter
4.Parameter
Parameter
Parameters can be called out directly by pressing the PARA button on
the main remote control unit.
a
Surround Parameter
Adjust surround sound parameters.
The adjustable parameters differ for the different surround modes
(vpage 64, 65).
MODE
Select the mode according to the playback source.
n In the PLgx or PLg mode
[Selectable items]
CINEMA
MUSIC
GAME
PL
z
z: Can be selected in the PLg mode.
n In the DTS NEO:6 mode
[Selectable items]
CINEMA
MUSIC
CINEMA
: Surround sound mode optimized for movie sources.
MUSIC
: Surround sound mode optimized for music sources.
GAME
: Surround sound mode optimized for games.
PL
: Dolby Pro Logic playback mode.
The MUSIC mode is also effective for movie sources including a lot of
stereo music.
CINEMA EQ
Soften the treble range of movie soundtracks for better
understanding.
[Selectable items]
ON
: CINEMA EQ is used.
OFF
: CINEMA EQ is not used.
D.COMP
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Turn dynamic range compression off.
LOW
: Low setting.
MID
: Middle setting.
HIGH
: High setting.
When playing DTS sources, this is only displayed for compatible
software.
DRC
Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds).
[Selectable items]
AUTO
: Automatic dynamic range compression on/off control
according to source.
LOW
: Low setting.
MID
: Middle setting.
HIGH
: High setting.
OFF
: Dynamic range compression always off.
This can be set in the Dolby TrueHD mode.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 41 2007/06/20 8:58:12
LFE
Adjust the low-frequency effects level (LFE).
[Variable range]
–10dB
~
0dB
CENTER IMAGE
Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider
sound.
[Variable range]
0.0
~
0.3
~
1.0
PANORAMA
Assign front L/R signal also to surround channels, for wider sound.
If the surround effect seems weak, set “PANORAMA” to “ON”.
[Selectable items]
ON
OFF
For proper playback of the different program sources, we recommend
setting to the values below.
Dolby Digital sources: “0 dB”
DTS movie sources: “0 dB”
DTS music sources: “-10 dB”
EFFECT
Switch effect signal for multi-surround speakers on and off.
When “EFFECT” is set to ON”, a surround effect with a strong sense
of expansion is achieved.
[Selectable items]
ON
OFF
DIMENSION
Shift sound image center to front or rear, to adjust playback balance.
[Variable range]
0
~
3
~
6
DELAY TIME
Adjust delay time to control sound stage size.
[Variable range]
0 ms
~
30 ms
~
300 ms
CENTER WIDTH
Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider
sound.
[Variable range]
0
~
3
~
7
LEVEL
Adjust effect signal level.
[Variable range]
1
~
10
~
15
Set to a lower level if the positioning and sense of phase of the
surround signals seems unnatural.
ROOM SIZE
Determine size of acoustic environment.
[Selectable items]
small
: Simulate acoustics of a small room.
med. s
medium
med. l
large
: Simulate acoustics of a large room.
NOTE
“ROOM SIZE” does not indicate the size of the room in which sources
are played.
Some Dolby Digital EX sources do not include EX flags. If the playback
mode does not switch automatically even when AFDM” is set to
ON”, set “SB CH OUT” to “MTRX ON” or “PLIIx CINEMA.
AFDM (Auto Flag Detect Mode)
Auto-select surround mode by source.
This function only works for software containing a special identification
signal.
If the software being played is recorded in Dolby Digital EX or DTS-ES,
it is played in 6.1-channels. If not, it is played in 5.1-channels.
[Selectable items]
ON
OFF
Example : Playing Dolby Digital software (with EX flag)
When AFDM” is set to ON”, the surround mode is automatically
set to the DOLBY + PLgx CINEMA mode.
To play in the Dolby Digital EX mode, set AFDM” to OFF” and “SB
CH OUT” to “MTRX ON”.
SB CH OUT (for Multi-channel sources)
Select playback mode for surround back channels.
[Selectable items]
OFF
: No signal is played from the surround back
channels.
NON MTRX
: The same signals as those of the surround
channels are output from the surround back
channels.
MTRX ON
: The surround channel signals undergo digital
matrix processing and are output from the
surround back channels.
PL
II
x CINEMA
z1
: Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Cinema mode,
surround back signal played.
PL
II
x MUSIC
z2
: Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music mode,
surround back signal played.
ES MTRX
z3
: DTS signal played with digital matrix processing.
ES DSCRT
z4
: Signal included in DTS-ES Discrete 6.1-channel
sources played.
z1: This can be selected when “Surround Back” is set to “2spkrs”
at the menu “Manual Setup” “Speaker Setup” “Speaker
Configuration” setting (vpage 26).
z2: This can be selected when “Surround Back” is set to “2spkrs”
or “1spkr” at the menu “Manual Setup” “Speaker Setup”
“Speaker Configuration” setting.
z3: This can be selected when playing DTS sources.
z4: This can be selected when playing DTS sources including a
discrete 6.1-channel signal identification signal.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 42 2007/06/20 8:58:14
SB CH OUT (for 2-channel sources)
Determine whether to use surround back speakers.
[Selectable items]
ON
: The surround channel signal is played.
OFF
: The surround channel signal is not played.
SUBWOOFER ATT.
Attenuate subwoofer level when using EXT. IN mode.
[Selectable items]
ON
: The input from the subwoofer channel is attenuated.
OFF
: The input from the subwoofer channel is not attenuated.
Usually use in this mode.
Set this to ON” if the subwoofer channel level seems too high when
playing Super Audio CDs.
Subwoofer
Turn subwoofer output on and off.
[Selectable items]
ON
: The subwoofer is used.
OFF
: The subwoofer is not used.
Default
Resets the settings to the default values.
s
Tone Control
Adjust the tonal quality of the sound.
Tone Defeat
Turn tone adjustments off.
[Selectable items]
ON
: Playback without tone adjustment.
OFF
: Allow tone adjustment (treble, bass).
The tone cannot be adjusted when in the DIRECT mode.
Bass
Adjust low frequency range (bass).
[Variable range]
–6dB ~ 6dB
Treble
Adjust high frequency range (treble).
[Variable range]
–6dB ~ 6dB
“Bass” and “Treble” can be set when “Tone Defeat” is set to OFF”.
d
Room EQ
Select room equalizer for current environment.
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
Press the ROOM EQ button on the main unit or the EQ button on the
main remote control.
Audyssey
Audyssey Byp. L/R
Audyssey Flat
ManualOFF
When Audyssey” is selected, ” lights.
When Audyssey Byp. L/R” or Audyssey Flat” is selected, or when
the auto setup measuring results have changed, ” lights.
Audyssey”, Audyssey Byp. L/R” and Audyssey Flat” can be set
after the auto setup procedure has been performed.
If the settings of speakers for which “Nonehas been determined
at “Auto Setup” are changed, “Audyssey”, “Audyssey Byp. L/R” and
Audyssey Flat” cannot be selected.
When using headphones, “Room EQ” is set to OFF”.
[Selectable items]
Audyssey
: Optimize frequency response of all speakers
to match room acoustics.
Audyssey Flat
: Optimize frequency response of all speakers to
flat response.
Audyssey Byp. L/R
: Optimize frequency response of speakers
except front speakers to match room
acoustics.
Manual
: Apply frequency response set with “Manual
EQ”.
OFF
: Turn equalizer off.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
This operation can be performed directly pressing the SURROUND BACK
button on the main unit.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 43 2007/06/20 8:58:14
f
RESTORER
This function restores compressed audio signals to how they
were before compression and corrects the sense of volume of
the bass to obtain richer playback sound.
[Selectable items]
OFF
:
Do not use RESTORER.
Mode1
(RESTORER 64):
Optimized mode for compressed sources with very weak highs.
Mode2
(RESTORER 96):
Apply suitable bass and treble boost for all compressed sources.
Mode3
(RESTORER HQ):
Optimized mode for compressed sources with normal highs.
g
Night Mode
Optimized setting for late-night listening.
Operating from the main remote control unit
Press the NGT button.
The indicator lights when “Low”, “Middle or “High” is
selected.
OFF Low Middle
High
[Selectable items]
OFF
: Turn night mode off.
LOW
: Turn late night mode on (Low setting).
MID
: Turn late night mode on (Mid setting).
HIGH
: Turn late night mode on (Hi setting).
h
Audio Delay
Compensate for mismatched timing between video and audio.
This cannot be adjusted when playing in the EXT. IN, DIRECT or
STEREO mode (with “Front Speaker” set to “Large, “Tone Defeat”
to ON” and “Room EQ” to OFF”.)
The adjustment range is 0 to 100 ms when the Auto Lipsync
Correction function is activated.
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
b When set using the procedure below, the on-screen display is not
displayed. Adjust while watching the display.
q Press the AUDIO DELAY button on the main unit or the A. DL button
on the main remote control unit.
w Use the o p button to set.
Delay audio.
This sets the delay time for audio signals.
[Variable range]
0 ms
~
200 ms
If you wish to adjust the “Audio Delay” while playing HDMI or
component video signals, press u to set on-screen display” to OFF”.
This way the audio delay can be adjusted while watching the picture.
(Press u again to switch to the on-screen display.)
Information
Status
Shows information about current settings.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
a
Main zone
Shows information about settings for main zone.
The items displayed differ according to the input source.
[Items to be checked]
Select Source
Name
Surround Mode
Input Mode
Rec Select
Video Select
Source Level
Room EQ
Night Mode
RESTORER
etc.
s
ZONE2 / ZONE3
Shows information about settings for multi-zone.
[Items to be checked]
Power
Select Source
Volume Level
Name :Record
Surround Mode:
STEREO
Select Source:
5-1.Status
PHONO
Input Mode :ANALOG
1/4

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
About the RESTORER function
Such compressed audio formats as MP3, WMA (Windows Media
Audio) and MPEG-4 AAC reduce the amount of data by eliminating
signal components that are hard for the human ear to hear. The
RESTORER function generates the signals eliminated upon
compression, restoring the sound to conditions near those of the
original sound before compression. It also corrects the sense of
volume of the bass to obtain richer sound with compressed audio
signals.
This is displayed on the menu and can be set when the input source
is selected to “XM”, or analog signals (including AM/FM signals) or
PCM signals (fs = 44.1/48 kHz) are input.
Operating from the main unit or main remote
control unit
During playback, press the RESTORER button on the main unit or the
RSTR button on the main remote control unit.
When set to something other than OFF”, ” is displayed.
OFF Mode 1 Mode 2
Mode 3
The default setting for “iPod” is “Mode3”. All others are set to OFF”.
(RESTORER 64)
(RESTORER 96)
(RESTORER HQ)
AVR2808CIEU.indd 44 2007/06/20 8:58:15
Audio Input Signal
Shows information about audio input signals.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
Dialogue normalization function
This is automatically activated when playing Dolby Digital sources.
This function automatically corrects the standard signal level for
individual program sources.
The correction value can be checked using the STATUS button on
the main unit.
The figure is the correction value when the standard level is
corrected.
[Items to be checked]
Surround Mode
: The currently set surround mode is displayed.
SIGNAL
: The input signal type is displayed.
fs
: The input signal’s sampling frequency is
displayed.
Format
: The number of channels in the input signal (front,
surround, LFE) is displayed.
Offset
: The dialogue normalization correction value is
displayed.
Flag
: “MATRIX” is displayed if the input signal has
undergone matrix processing, “DISCRETE” if the
input signal has undergone discrete processing.
HDMI Information
Shows information about HDMI input/output signals and monitor.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
a
HDMI Signal Information
The HDMI input/output signal information is displayed.
[Items to be checked]
Resolution
Color Space
Pixel Depth
s
HDMI Monitor Information
The HDMI monitor information is displayed.
[Items to be checked]
Interface
Support Resolution
Auto Surround Mode
Shows information about auto surround mode settings.
The surround mode for which the last memory function was used
for the different input signal types is displayed.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
[Items to be checked]
Analog/PCM 2CH
Multi ch
Digital 2CH
Digital 5.1CH
Quick Select
Shows information about quick select settings.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
For instructions on storing settings at Quick Select 1 to 3, see page
50.
[Items to be checked]
Name
Input Source
Input Mode
Volume Level
Analog/PCM 2CH
Multi ch
Digital 2CH
Digital 5.1CH
Preset Station
Shows information about preset stations.
F Menu screen F
2.Audio Input Signal
3.HDMI Information
4.Auto Surround Mode
5.Quick Select
6.Preset Station
1.Status
5.Information
[Input source]
TUNER
XM
[Items to bechecked]
A1 ~ G8
When the STATUS button on the main unit is pressed, the set’s status
can be checked on the display.
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
SIGNAL:Dolby Digital
fs :48kHz
Format:3/2/.1
Offset:-4dB
Surround Mode:
5-2.Audio Input Signal
480i
1080p
Color Space
YCbCr 4:2:2
YCbCr 4:4:4
Pixel Depth
8bits
10bits
Resolution
5-3.HDMI Signal Info.
5-4.Auto Surround Mode
[Analog][PCM]
2
CH
:STEREO
[Multi ch]
:MULTI CH IN
[Digital]
2
CH
:DOLBY PL
II
x Cinema
5.1
CH
:DOLBY/DTS SURROUND
5-6.Preset Station
A1
FM
87.50M
Hz
A2
FM
89.10M
Hz
A3
FM
98.10M
Hz
A4
FM
107.90M
Hz
A5
FM
90.10M
Hz
A6
FM
90.10M
Hz
A7
FM
90.10M
Hz
A8
FM
90.10M
Hz
5-5.Quick Select
1/2
1.Quick Select 1
2.Quick Select 2
3.Quick Select 3

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 45 2007/06/20 8:58:16
<POWER>
<PHONES>
<ON/STANDBY>
<SOURCE> <TUNING PRESET> MASTER VOLUME
SOURCE SELECT
SPEAKER
Playback
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
Preparations
1
Press <POWER>.
The power indicator lights red and the power is set to the standby
mode.
2
Press <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER ON].
The power indicator flashes green and the power turns on.
To operate the AVR-2808CI using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control
Unit Operations”).
Turning the Power Off
q Press <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER OFF].
The power is set to the standby mode.
w Press <POWER>.
The power indicator turns off, and so does the power.
NOTE
Power continues to be supplied to some of the circuitry even when
the power is in the standby mode. When leaving home for long periods
of time or when traveling, either press <POWER> to turn off the power,
or unplug the power cord from the power outlet.
Turning the Power On
Either turn <MASTER VOLUME> or press [MASTER
VOLUME].
Operations During Playback
Adjusting the Master Volume
Press [MUTE].
To cancel, press [MUTE] again. Muting can also be canceled by adjusting
the master volume.
Plug the headphones into <PHONES>.
The sound from the speakers and pre-out connectors is automatically
cut.
NOTE
Be careful not to set the volume too high when using headphones.
Turning Off the Sound Temporarily (Muting)
Listening with Headphones
To operate the AVR-2808CI using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control
Unit Operations”).
Selecting the input source
Operation on the main unit
Turn <SOURCE SELECT>.
If “Rec Select” or “Video Select” is selected for the input source,
press <SOURCE> before turning <SOURCE SELECT>.
Operation on the main remote control unit
Press [SOURCE SELECT].
The desired input source can be selected directly.
[TUNER]
SOURCE
SELECT
[POWER ON]
[MUTE]
[POWER OFF]
MASTER
VOLUME
SPEAKER
[ AMP]
[ TU]
[BAND]
[A ~ G]
[MODE]
[MEMO]
[d f]
[1 ~ 8]
[SHIFT]
[CHANNEL]

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
Press SPEAKER.
Front A Front B
Front A+B
Switching the front speakers
( mode)
AVR2808CIEU.indd 46 2007/06/20 8:58:18
Presetting Radio Stations
(Preset Memory)
Your favorite broadcast stations can be preset so that you can tune
them in easily. Up to 56 stations can be preset.
1
Tune in the broadcast station you want to preset.
2
Press [MEMO].
3
Press [A ~ G] to select the block in which the station is
to be preset, then press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select
the preset number.
b The memory block can also be selected by pressing [SHIFT].
4
Press [MEMO] again to complete the setting.
To preset other stations, repeat steps 1 to 4.
Stations can be preset automatically at menu “Input Setup” – “Auto
Preset” (vpage 34).
NOTE
Preset stations are erased by overwriting them.
1
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER]
(AMP mode) to select “TUNER”.
2
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
Press [BAND] to select “FM” or “AM”.
4
Tune in the desired broadcast station.
q To tune in automatically (Auto Tuning)
Press [MODE] to light the AUTO” indicator on the display, then use
[df] to select the station you want to hear.
w To tune in manually (Manual Tuning)
Press [MODE] to turn off the display’s AUTOindicator, then use
[df] to select the station you want to hear.
Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts
It is also possible to switch to “FM” or AM” in step 1 by pressing
[TUNER].
If the desired station cannot be tuned in with auto tuning, tune it in
manually.
When tuning in stations manually, press and hold [df] to change
frequencies continuously.
The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu
“Manual Setup” Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” (vpage
31, 32).
Basic Operation
Press <TUNING PRESET>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT>
to select the preset radio station.
Listening to Preset Stations
Operation on the Main Unit
Operation on the Main Remote Control Unit
1
Press [A ~ G] to select the memory block.
2
Press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select the desired preset
channel.
n Default settings
Auto tuner presets
A1 ~ A8
87.5 / 89.1 / 98.1 / 107.9 / 90.1 / 90.1 / 90.1 /
90.1 MHz
B1 ~ B8
520 / 600 / 1000 / 1400 / 1500 / 1710 kHz,
90.1 / 90.1 MHz
C1 ~ C8
90.1 MHz
D1 ~ D8
90.1 MHz
E1 ~ E8
90.1 MHz
F1 ~ F8
90.1 MHz
G1 ~ G8
90.1 MHz
Playing Video and Audio Equipment
1
Prepare the equipment.
q Load the DVD, CD or other software in the player.
(vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.)
w To play a video device, switch the monitor input.
(vSee the monitors operating instructions.)
2
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the AMP mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
Use SOURCE SELECT to select the input source.
4
Start playback.
(vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.)
Basic Operation

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 47 2007/06/20 8:58:18
Note: The XM Radio ID does not use the letters “I”, O, “S” or
“F”. Activate your XM Satellite Radio service in the U.S. online at
http://activate.xmradio.com or call 1-800-XM-RADIO (1-800-967-
2346). You will need a major credit card. XM will send a signal from
the satellites to activate the full channel lineup. Activation normally
takes 10 to 15 minutes, but during peak busy periods you may need to
keep your XM Ready home audio system on for up to an hour. When
you can access the full channel lineup on your XM Ready home audio
system you are done. For more information or to subscribe in Canada,
visit XM on the Web at www.xmradio.ca or call XM’s Listener Care at
1-877-GET-XMSR (1-877-438-9677).
1
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [SAT TU]
(AMP mode) to select “XM”.
2
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
3
Use [df] to select the station.
When the station is tuned in, the name of the track and artist
are displayed.
The channel switches continuously when [df] is pressed and held.
XM Radio stations can be preset using the same procedure as for
FM/AM stations (vpage 44 “Presetting Radio Stations (Preset
Memory)” and “Listening to Preset Stations”).
The artist name, track name, category and reception level can be
checked by pressing <STATUS>.
The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu
“Manual Setup” Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” (vpage
31, 32).
About XM Satellite Radio
XM Satellite Radio offers an extraordinary variety of commercial-free
music, plus the best in sports, news, talk and entertainment. XM
is broadcast in superior digital audio from coast to coast. From rock
to reggae, from classical to hip hop, XM has something for every
music fan. XM’s dedication to playing the richest selection of music
is matched by its passion for live sporting events, talk radio, up-to-
the-minute news, stand-up comedy, childrens programming, and
much more. For U.S. customers, information about XM Satellite Radio
is available online at www.xmradio.com. For Canadian customers,
information about XM Canada is online at www.xmradio.ca.
XM Ready
®
Legal
Hardware and required monthly subscription sold separately. Other fees
and taxes, including a one-time activation fee may apply. Subscription
fee is consumer only. All fees and programming subject to change.
Channels with frequent explicit language are indicated with an XL.
Channel blocking is available for XM radio receivers by calling 1-800-
XMRADIO (US residents) and 1-877-GET-XMSR (Canadian residents).
For a full listing of the XM commercial-free channels and advertising-
supported channels, visit lineup.xmradio.com (US residents) or
xmradio.ca (Canadian residents).
Subscriptions subject to Customer Agreement available at
xmradio.com (US residents) and xmradio.ca (Canadian residents).
Only available in the 48 contiguous United States and Canada. ©2006
XM Satellite Radio Inc. All rights reserved. All other trademarks are the
property of their respective owners.
XM Ready
®
Subscriptions
Once you have installed the XM Mini-Tuner Dock, inserted the XM
Mini-Tuner, connected the XM Dock to your XM Ready® home audio
system, and installed the antenna, you are ready to subscribe and
begin receiving XM programming. There are three places to find your
eight character XM Radio ID: on the XM Mini-Tuner, on the XM Mini-
Tuner package, and on XM Channel 0. Record the Radio ID in the
following eight squares for reference.
Listening to XM Satellite Radio
Programs
Basic Operation
<SOURCE SELECT> <STATUS>
ENTER uiop
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
[SEARCH]
[BAND]
[NUMBER]
[d f]
uiop
ENTER
[SAT TU]
[MODE]
[ TU]

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 48 2007/06/20 8:58:19
Searching Categories
1
Press o p.
2
Use o p to select the category, then use ui to select
the desired station.
Accessing XM Radio Stations Directly
1
Press [SEARCH].
2
Press [NUMBER] then input the station’s channel.
Example: Accessing station “XM123”:
[1] [2] [3]
b If no button is pressed within several seconds, the station
automatically switches to the one whose number has been input.
3
Press ENTER to set that station.
Reception switches to the selected station.
“LOADING” is displayed while stations or data are being received.
“UPDATING” is displayed while the encoding code is being
updated.
“XM - - -” is displayed if the selected channel cannot be used.
Channel category
Checking the XM Signal Strength and
Radio ID
1
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [SAT TU]
(AMP mode) to select “XM”.
2
Press <STATUS> until “SIGNAL” appears on the
display.
The display will switch as shown below, depending on the
reception conditions.
Display Status
GOOD Signal strength is good
MARGINAL Signal strength is marginal
WEAK Signal strength is weak
NO No signal
3
Adjust the position of the antenna until “SIGNAL:
GOOD” is shown on the display.
4
Press <STATUS> until the station you want to check
(example: “XM001”) is displayed.
5
Press [df] and select channel 0 (XM000).
The radio ID is shown on the display.
The strength of both the XM satellite and terrestrial signals can be
checked at menu “Input Setup” – Antenna Aiming” (vpage 36).
Radio ID

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 49 2007/06/20 8:58:20
NOTE
Depending on the type of iPod and the software version, some
functions may not operate.
DENON will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any loss of iPod
data.
Listening to Music
1
Use ui to select the menu, then press ENTER or p
to select the music  le to be played.
2
Press ENTER.
Playback starts.
Stopping playback temporarily
During playback, press ENTER or [1].
Press again to resume playback.
Fast-forwarding or fast-reversing
During playback, either press and hold u (to fast-reverse) or i (to
fast-forward), or press [6] or [7].
To cue to the beginning of a track
During playback, either press u (to cue to the previous track) or i (to
cue to the next track), or press [8] or [9].
To stop
During playback, either press and hold ENTER or press [2].
Playing repeatedly
Press [CHANNEL –].
[Selectable items]
All
One
Off
MENU : ”Input Setup” ”iPod” “Repeat” (vpage 35)
With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR
(iPod) connector.
Press <ON/STANDBY> and set the AVR-2808CI’s power to the
standby mode before disconnecting the iPod. Also switch the input
source to one to which the menu “iPod dock” is not assigned before
disconnecting the iPod.
iPod
®
Playback
The music on an iPod can be played by using the Control Dock for
iPod (ASD-1R, ASD-3N or ASD-3W, sold separately).
The operation can also be performed using the buttons on the main
unit or remote control unit while watching the menus.
iPod is a trademark of Apple Computer, Inc., registered in
the U.S. and other countries.
b The iPod may only be used to copy or play contents that are not
copyrighted or contents for which copying or playback is legally
permitted for your private use as an individual. Be sure to comply
with applicable copyright legislation.
1
Make the necessary preparations.
q Set the iPod in the DENON Control Dock for iPod.
(vSee the Control Dock for iPod’s operating instructions.)
w Assign the Control Dock for iPod’s input.
MENU : ”Input Setup” “Assign” ”iPod dock”
(vpage 36)
2
Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [iPod] (AMP
mode) to select the input source assigned in step 1-w
above.
(iPod screen)
b If the screens above are not displayed, the iPod may not be
properly connected. Try connecting again.
3
To operate using the main remote control unit, set the
remote control unit to the iPod mode.
(vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”)
OK to disconnect
Basic Operation
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
<ON/STANDBY> <STATUS>
ENTERINPUT MODE uiop
uiop
[SEARCH]
[ iPod]
[iPod]
[CHANNEL
+ –
]
ENTER
INPUT MODE
[8],[9],
[6],[7],
[1],[2]

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
(AMP mode)
AVR2808CIEU.indd 50 2007/06/20 8:58:22
Other Operations and
Functions
Other Operations
Playing Super Audio CDs
1
At the “HDMI” setting (vpage 35), select the input
source for “HDMI” is assigned.
The ” indicator lights on the display.
2
Use INPUT MODE to select “Auto” (vpage 34).
Select the input mode according to the program source to be
played.
3
Select the surround mode (vpage 36 ~ 38).
We recommend playing in the DIRECT mode.
4
Start playing the Super Audio CD.
The ” indicator lights on the display.
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s
operating instructions.
When playing DSD signals in the DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode,
the DSD signals are converted as such into analog signals. When
playing in other surround modes, the DSD signals are fi rst converted
into PCM format, then into analog signals.
“DSD DIRECT” is shown on the display when playing DSD 2-channel
signals in the DIRECT mode. “DSD MULTI DIRECT” is shown on
the display when playing DSD multi--channel signals in the DIRECT
mode.
Shuffl ing playback
Press [CHANNEL +].
[Selectable items]
Albums
Songs
OFF
MENU : ”Input Setup” ”iPod” “Shuffl e” (vpage 36)
Searching up or down pages
Press [SEARCH], then press o (down) or p (up).
To cancel, press ui or [SEARCH].
To switch between the Browse and Remote modes
Either press and hold [SEARCH].
The title name, artist name and album name can be checked by
pressing <STATUS> during playback.
On the AVR-2808CI, folder and le names can be displayed as
titles. Any characters that cannot be displayed are replaced with “ .
(period)”.
The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu
“Manual Setup” Option Setup” On-Screen Display” “iPod
Information” (vpage 32).
Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the
iPod
Photo and video data on the iPod can be viewed on the monitor.
Only for iPods equipped with slideshow or video functions. (When
using an ASD-1R)
1
Press and hold [SEARCH] to set the Remote mode.
2
Watching the iPod’s screen, use ui to select
“Photos” or “Video”.
3
Press ENTER until the image you want to view is
displayed.
“TV Out” at the iPod’s “Slideshow Settings” or “Video Settings” must
be set to “ON” in order to display the iPod’s photo data or videos on
the monitor. For details, see the iPod’s operating instructions.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 51 2007/06/20 8:58:23
To cancel, press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT>
until “ZONE2 SOURCE” is displayed.
Make a test recording before starting the actual recording.
Signals are only output to the analog REC OUT connectors when
the digital signals input to the digital input connectors (OPTICAL/
COAXIAL) are PCM (2-channel) signals.
Digital audio signals input to the HDMI connectors are not output
to the REC OUT connectors, so connect using the OPTICAL or
COAXIAL connectors.
Sources selected with the REC OUT mode are output from ZONE2
as well.
In the REC OUT mode, the remote control unit’s ZONE2 mode
buttons cannot be operated.
The “XM” digital audio output signals are not output from the
OPTICAL2 or OPTICAL3 output connectors.
NOTE
Recordings you make are for your personal enjoyment and should
not be used for other purposes without permission of the copyright
holder.
Input sources for which “Deleteis selected at “Source Delete”cannot
be selected.
Recording on an External Device
(REC OUT mode)
You can listen to one program source while recording a different
program source.
1
Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>.
“ZONE2 SOURCE” is shown on the display.
ZONE2 SOURCE ZONE2 TUNER ZONE2 XM····
RECOUT XM RECOUT TUNER RECOUT SOURCE······
2
Turn <SOURCE SELECT> until “RECOUT SOURCE”
is displayed.
The ” indicator lights.
3
Turn <SOURCE SELECT> to choose the input source
to be recorded.
4
Play the program source.
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s
operating instructions.
To record FM or AM broadcasts, select the broadcast (vpage
44).
5
Start recording.
For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s
operating instructions.
CH SELECT
<POWER>
<ZONE2/3 / RECSELECT>
<STANDARD> <DSP SIMULATION>
SOURCE SELECT
QUICK SELECT
uiop
QUICK SELECT
uio p
CH SELECT
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 52 2007/06/20 8:58:24
Quick Select Function
With this function, the currently playing input source, input mode,
surround mode, room EQ settings and volume can be stored in
the memory.
1
Set the input source, input mode, surround mode,
room EQ settings and volume to the conditions you
want to store.
2
Press and hold the desired QUICK SELECT.
Keep pressing the button until the quick select indicator lights.
To call out the settings, press QUICK SELECT at which the desired
settings were stored.
The Quick Select name can be changed (vpage 32).
NOTE
Input sources stored with the quick select function cannot be selected
if they have been deleted at menu “Manual Setup” – Option Setup”
“Source Delete” (vpage 31). In this case, store them again.
Input Source Volume
Quick Select 1 DVD –40 dB
Quick Select 2 TV/CBL –40 dB
Quick Select 3 VCR –40 dB
[Quick Select Defaults]
Personal Memory Plus Function
This function sets the settings (input mode, surround mode, etc.)
last selected for the individual input sources.
When you switch to an input source, the settings are automatically
set to the ones that were set the last time that input source was
used.
The surround parameters, tone control, room EQ settings and the
volumes of the different speakers are stored for the individual surround
modes.
Last Function Memory
This stores the settings as they were directly before the standby
mode was set.
When the power is turned back on, the settings are restored to as
they were directly before the standby mode was set.
Backup Memory
The various settings are backed up for about 1 week, even if the
power is turned off or the power cord is disconnected.
1
Press CH SELECT.
2
Press ui or CH SELECT to select “Fader”.
3
Use o p to adjust the volume of the speakers.
(o: front, p: rear)
The fader function does not affect the subwoofer.
The fader can be adjusted until the volume of the speaker adjusted
to the lowest value is –12 dB.
Fader Function
This function lets you adjust (fade) the sound from all the front or
rear speakers at once.
Convenient Functions
1
Press CH SELECT.
Channel Volume
FL 0.0
dB
SR 0.0
dB
C 0.0
dB
SBR 0.0
dB
FR 0.0
dB
SBL 0.0
dB
SW 0.0
dB
SL 0.0
dB
Fader
FRONT : REAR
2
Use ui or CH SELECT to select the speaker.
The speaker that can be set switches each time one of the
buttons is pressed.
3
Use o p to adjust the volume.
bOFF” can be set by pressing o when the subwoofer’s volume is
set to –12 dB.
Channel Level
You can adjust the channel level either according to the playback
sources or to suit your taste, as described below.
Resetting the Microprocessor
Perform this procedure if the display is abnormal or if operations
cannot be performed.
When the microprocessor is reset, all the settings are reset to
their default values.
1
Turn off the power using <POWER>.
2
Press <POWER> while simultaneously pressing
<STANDARD> and <DSP SIMULATION>.
3
Once the display starts ashing at intervals of about 1
second, release the two buttons.
If in step 3 the display does not flash at intervals of about 1 second,
start over from step 1.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 53 2007/06/20 8:58:25
Remote Control Unit Operations
Main Remote Control Unit
On the main remote control unit, the display switches according
to the device being operated and the mode.
In modes other than iPod, the mode switches between“
and ” each time the [MODE SELECTOR] is pressed.
In the AMP, TUNER and iPod modes, when the remote ID is
set, the AVR-2808CI can be used independently even in an
environment containing multiple DENON amplifiers.
Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your equipment,
some buttons may not operate.
NOTE
The device mode (“ or ”) cannot be changed while the
setting is being made.
Operating DENON Audio Components
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be
operated.
The indicator for the component to be operated flashes.
: AMP / ZONE2 / ZONE3 /
ZONE4
z
/ SYSTEM CALL
: TUNER (FM/AM) / XM
: NET/USB /
DIGITAL TUNER
z
: Satellite Receiver / Cable TV
: iPod
: DVD player (Recorder) /
CD player (Recorder)
: VCR / TAPE
: TV
z The AVR-2808CI cannot be used in the ZONE4 and NET/DTU
modes.
b The mode switches each time [AMP] is pressed.
G
AMP modeH GZONE2 modeH GZONE3 modeH
GSYSTEM CALL modeH GZONE4 modeH
2
Operate the component.
b For details, refer to the component’s operating instructions.
[HOME] is used to return to the AMP mode (AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3,
ZONE4 or SYSTEM CALL) when in any mode other than AMP.
Presetting
The included main remote control unit can be preset to operate
devices of various brands.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
preset.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [NUMBER] and input the 5-digit number of the
brand of the component to be preset. The numbers
are shown in the Preset Code Table (vEnd of this
manual).
When the code is registered, the signal transmission indicator
flashes twice.
When the preset code is transmitted, the mode indicator for the
component to which that code belongs flashes.
b The input mode is canceled if no button is operated for 10
seconds.
Some brands have more than one preset code. If the component does
not operate, try inputting a different code.
Operating Preset Components
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be
operated.
The mode indicator of the device to be operated flashes.
2
Operate the component.
b For details, refer to the component’s operating instructions.
[ AMP]
[NUMBER]
[MODE SELECTOR]
[RC SETUP]
Signal transmission
indicator

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 54 2007/06/20 8:58:26
[MENU]
[CH + /
SHUFFLE],
[CH – /
REPEAT]
[SETUP/
SEARCH]
[ENTER]
[RETURN]
[0 ~ 9, +10]
[uiop]
[1],
[8 9],
[6 7], [3],
[2],
[SOURCE ON],
[SOURCE OFF]
EL Display
MODE SELECTOR DVD VCR iPod
Device Mode
Device operated
DVD
(Default setting)
DVD Recorder
CD
(Default setting)
CD Recorder VCR TAPE iPod
1
Playback Playback Playback Playback Playback Playback Playback/Pause
8 9
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
Auto search
(cue)
6 7
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
Manual search
(fast-reverse/
fast-forward)
3
Pause Pause Pause Pause Pause Pause
2
Stop Stop Stop Stop Stop Stop Stop
SOURCE ON Power on Power on Power on
SOURCE OFF Power off Power off Power off
Buttons
MENU Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu
u i o p
Cursor Cursor Cursor Cursor
ENTER Enter setting Enter setting Enter setting Enter
SETUP/SEARCH Set up Set up Set up
Page forward
screen / Browse/
Remote mode
switching (Press
and hold)
RETURN Return Return Cancel Return
CH + / SHUFFLE Switch channels
1-track/album
shuffle play
CH - / REPEAT Switch channels
1-track/All-track
repeat play
0 ~ 9, +10 Select track Select track Select track Select track
Special Remarks
q, w q q q
Functions of Buttons by Component
GSpecial RemarksH
q Only one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared.
w The names of the functions for the DVD remote control buttons differ from brand to brand. Check beforehand.
NOTE
Preset a DVD player or DVD recorder for the DVD ( ) mode. Preset a CD player or CD recorder for the DVD ( ) mode.
Preset a VCR for the VCR ( ) mode. Preset a tape deck for the VCR ( ) mode.
EL Display
Buttons

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 55 2007/06/20 8:58:28

[MENU]
[CH +/–]
[TV/VCR]
[ENTER]
[DISPLAY]
[0 ~ 9, +10]
[uiop]
[SETUP]
[1],
[8 9],
[6 7], [3],
[2],
[SOURCE ON],
[SOURCE OFF]
EL Display
MODE SELECTOR TV Satellite Receiver / Cable TV
Device Mode
Device operated TV (HITACHI) TV (SONY) SAT SAT
1
Punch through Punch through Punch through Punch through
8 9
6 7
3
2
SOURCE ON Power on Power on Power on Power on
SOURCE OFF Power off Power off Power off Power off
Buttons
MENU Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu/guide Menu/guide
u i o p
Cursor Cursor Cursor Cursor
ENTER Enter setting Enter setting Enter setting Enter setting
SETUP Set up Set up Set up Set up
DISPLAY Display Display Display Display
CH + / – Switch channels Switch channels Switch channels Switch channels
0 ~ 9, +10 Channel selection Channel selection Channel selection Channel selection
TV/VCR Switch inputs Switch inputs
Special Remarks
q, e q, e q, e q, e
GSpecial RemarksH
q Only one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared.
e The CD, VCR or DVD buttons (one only set) can be assigned to the monitor, satellite receiver and cable TV (vpage 55 “Punch Through
Function”).
EL Display
Buttons
[CH +/–]
[SEARCH]
[SHIFT]
[A ~ G], [d f],
[BAND],
[MODE],
[MEMO]
[ENTER]
[0 ~ 9]
[uiop]
EL Display
MODE SELECTOR TU
Device Mode
Device operated Analog tuner XM
A ~ G Preset memory block selection Preset memory block selection
d f
Tuning + / Channel selection
BAND AM/FM switching
MODE Switch search modes
MEMO Preset memory registration Preset memory registration
Buttons
u i o p
Category search
ENTER
SEARCH Direct search
CH + / – Preset channel selection Preset channel selection
0 ~ 9 Preset channel selection (1 ~ 8)
Preset channel selection (1 ~ 8) /
Direct channel search (0 ~ 9)
SHIFT Switch memory block Switch memory block
EL Display
Buttons

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 56 2007/06/20 8:58:29
MODE
SELECTOR
Remote ID
AMP (MAIN)
TUNER
iPod
(Analog
TUNER)
(XM)
1
(Default)
81001 52863 52864 72815
2 82001 52795 52812 72816
3 83001 52800 52813 72817
4 84001
52805 52814
72818
Setting the Remote ID
When using multiple DENON AV receivers in the same room,
make this setting so that only the desired AV receiver operates.
1
Press [AMP] to set the main remote control unit to the
AMP mode.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Refer to the table at the right, and use [NUMBER] to
input the 5-digit number corresponding to the remote
ID to be changed.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press [TU] or [iPod] to select the mode to be set.
5
Repeat steps 2 to 4 to set the remote IDs for all
modes.
NOTE
When changing a setting, be sure to set the same remote ID as the
AVR-2808CI’s (vpage 32).
When changing the AMP mode’s remote ID, also change the
“TUNER” and “iPod” remote ID at the same time.
Set the remote ID of an analog tuner for TUNER ( ), the XM
remote ID for
.
5
Point the main remote control units directly at each
other and press and hold the button on the other
device’s remote control unit that you want to learn.
Once learning is completed normally, the display lights and the
signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
b If you want to learn other buttons, repeat steps 4 and 5.
b The mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR].
b The signal transmission indicator lights once for a long time if
learning was not possible
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting
is completed.
[ AMP]
[NUMBER]
[MODE SELECTOR]
[RC SETUP]
[ TU]
[ iPod]
Other devices
remote control unit
AVR-2808CI’s main remote
control unit (RC-1068)
Learning Function
If your AV devices are of a brand other than DENON or if they
cannot be operated with the preset memory function, their
remote control signals can be transfered to stored in the AVR-
2808CI’s main remote control unit.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
set.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [5], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the learning
mode is set.
4
Press the button to be set.
The main remote control unit’s display turns off.
b If a button that cannot be learned is pressed, the signal transmission
indicator lights but the signal is not learned.
With some remote control units, the signals cannot be learned or the
device will not operate properly even when the signals have been
learned. In this case, use the devices own remote control unit.
Learned buttons have priority over the preset memory. If you no
longer need the learned setting, reset the learning function (vpage
56).
NOTE
[HOME] cannot be learned.
Do not learn any remote control signals at [RC SETUP].
The AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3, ZONE4 and SYSTEM CALL modes cannot
be learned.
Signal transmission
indicator

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 57 2007/06/20 8:58:30
System Call Function
This function lets you register a series of operations at a single
button.
For example, the amplifier can be turned on, the input source
selected, the monitors power turned on, the source device’s
power turned on and the play mode set all by pressing a single
button.
Up to 32 signals each can be registered at [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2
or 3).
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
register.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the system
call registration mode is set.
4
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which you want to
register the signals.
5
Press the buttons you want to register in the same
sequence as the operations you want to perform.
The signal transmission indicator lights when a button is
pressed.
Example : Press [POWER ON].
Press [MODE SELECTOR][DVD].
Press [1].
b The mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR].
b Perform the registration procedure for all the buttons you want to
register.
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting
is completed.
Calling out
1
Press [AMP], to select “SYSTEM CALL”.
2
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which the signals
were registered.
The registered signals are transmitted in the registered
sequence.
Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [9], [7] and [3], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the backlight
on time setting mode is set.
3
Set the light on time.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
[Settable times] : [1] : 5 sec.
[2] : 10 sec. (Default)
[3] : 15 sec.
[4] : 20 sec.
[5] : 25 sec.
Registering
Punch Through Function
CD, DVD or VCR mode buttons can be stored at unused TV
or SAT/CBL mode buttons.
For example, when DVD mode buttons are assigned to
the TV mode, the DVD mode operations can be performed
while in the TV mode.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
punch through (CD, DVD or VCR).
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the punch
through setting mode is set.
4
Press the button you want to punch through (1, 2,
6, 7, 8, 9 or 3).
5
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
punch through (TV or SAT/CBL).
6
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting
is completed.
[NUMBER]
[RC SETUP]
[MODE
SELECTOR]
[ AMP]
[POWER
ON]
[SYSTEM
CALL]
[CHANNEL
+/–]
[8],
[9],
[6],
[7],
[1], [3],
[2]
Signal
transmission
indicator

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 58 2007/06/20 8:58:31
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press the button you want to reset twice.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit
Learning Function
GResetting button by buttonH
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset.
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset twice.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
GResetting by device modeH
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) you want to reset.
4
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
1
Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to
reset (TV or SAT/CBL).
2
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
3
Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
4
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [9], [8] and [1], in that order.
The signal transmission indicator flashes 4 times.
All the settings are restored to their defaults.
System call function
Punch-through function
All settings
Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness
The display’s brightness can be adjusted in 5 steps.
(Default: Step 3)
1
Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds.
The signal transmission indicator flashes twice.
2
Press [CHANNEL +] or [CHANNEL –].
The display gets one step brighter when [+] is pressed.
The display gets one step darker when [–] is pressed.
3
Press [RC SETUP] to complete the setting.
About the zone remote control
unit (RC-1071)
The sub remote control unit (RC-1071) included with the AVR-
2808CI can be used as the exclusive multi-zone remote control
unit.
b The following describes operation for the selected zone. (Use
[ZONE SELECT] to switch zones.)
Turning the multi-zone power on and off
Selecting the input source to be played
Adjusting and temporarily muting the multi-zone volume
Listening to the tuner
Operating an iPod (Note that [FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY] can only
be used with the ASD-3W/3N.)

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
[CHANNEL+ /
]
[POWER OFF]
[REPEAT]
[POWER ON]
[RANDOM]
[SHIFT]
[MUTE]
[VOLUME+ /
]
[FAVORITES
[DIRECT PLAY]
[SOURCE SELECT]
[ZONE SELECT]
[TUNING+ /
]
[8],[9],
[1/3],[2]
ZONE SELECT Switching the zone to be operated
POWER OFF Power off
POWER ON Power on
SOURCE SELECT Switching the input zone
VOLUME + / - Volume control
CHANNEL + / - Channel + / –
TUNING + / - Tuning + / –
MUTE Muting
SHIFT Switching the memory block
8 9
Auto search (cue)
2
Stop
1/3
Play / Pause
FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY Playing files registered at FAVORITES
REPEAT 1-track / All -track repeat play
RANDOM 1-track / album shuffle play
b When using a Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R),
[
FAVORITES DIRECT
PLAY] cannot be used.
AVR2808CIEU.indd 59 2007/06/20 8:58:32

Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and
Operations
The AVR-2808CI is compatible with the following types of playback:
Multi-zone playback (ZONE2 & ZONE3)
Bi-amp playback (front speakers)
NOTE
For bi-amp playback, use speakers compatible with that type of connection.
When conducting bi-amp playback, remove the short-circuiting boards (or wires) from the speaker
terminals.
Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function
The amp assign function lets you assign the amplifiers for the different channels built into the AVR-2808CI
to the speaker outputs for the different zones.
Select the desired playback environment from among “Setting 1” to “Setting 4”, then set the corresponding
Amp Assign” mode at menu “Manual Setup” – Option Setup” – Amp Assign” (vpage 31).
Connect the speakers as described at Amp Assign mode settings and speakers connected to the various
speaker terminals”.
Z2L Z2R
Z2L Z2R
Z2
ZONE2/3-MONO
FL
SW C FR
SL SR
Main zone
ZONE2
Stereo
Mono
5.1ch
ZONE2
Setting 1 :
F Multi-zone playback
5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 or ZONE3 stereo playback
5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 + ZONE3 monaural playback
Amp Assign mode:
“STEREOor “MONOdepends on the setting at menu “Manual Setup” “(select the zone)” “Zone
Setup” – “Channel” (vpage 30).
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Z3L Z3R
Z3L Z3R
Z3
ZONE3
Stereo
Mono
+
+
+
+
+
+
ZONE3
(Default)
“Setting 3” is possible to switch the Amp Assign mode between the 5.1-channel mode and 2-channel
mode without changing the speaker connections.
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK /
AMP ASSIGN
R L R L R L
ZONE2
FR FL C SR SL
Z2R Z2L
ZONE3 Z3R Z3L
ZONE2/3-MONO
Z3
(MONO)
Z2
(MONO)

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 60 2007/06/20 8:58:33
SBL SBR
FL
SW C FR
SL SR
Main zone
7.1ch
Setting 2 :
F 7.1-channel playback
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Setting 3 : With this setting it is possible to switch between the following two playback modes.
F 5.1-channel playback
F 2-channel playback
Switching ················Surround Mode switching
Surround Mode
DIRECT / STEREO
Multi Channel /
Surround
FL
C FR
SW
L R
SL SR
Main zone
5.1ch
FL
C FR
SW
L R
SL SR
Main zone
2ch
2ch
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK /
AMP ASSIGN
R L R L R L
2ch FR FL C SR SL FR FL
Amp Assign mode:
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK /
AMP ASSIGN
R L R L R L
7.1ch FR FL C SR SL SBR SBL
7.1ch
Amp Assign mode:

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 61 2007/06/20 8:58:33
$
'- 48 '3
4-
43
4#
3
4#
-
ZONE3 audio output
Main zone (7.1-channel system)
Monitor
ZONE2
ZONE3
DVD player
Input
Remote
control unit
ZONE2
audio output
ZONE2
video output
AVR-2808CI
Monitor
Power amplifier
Power amplifier
: Multi-zone video cable
: Multi-zone audio cable
When only using one speaker for ZONE2 or ZONE3, set to “Mono. In this case, the ZONE2 (ZONE3)
monaural output is output from the ZONE2 (ZONE3) pre-out L and R connectors, so connect as desired.
Separate power amplifiers are needed for ZONE2 and ZONE3.
Connectors for audio output Audio signals Connectors for video output
ZONE2 ZONE2 PRE OUT Stereo ZONE2 VIDEO OUT
ZONE3 ZONE3 PRE OUT Stereo
Multi-zone Settings and Operations with Zone Pre-out
Output
Prepare power amplifiers for ZONE2 and ZONE3.
Remote
control unit
Setting 4 :
F Making bi-amp connections for the FL and FR channels in the main zone
and conducting 5.1-channel playback
(switching with other modes not possible)
Speaker terminal
Amp Assign mode
FRONT-A FRONT-B
CENTER
SURR
SURR. BACK / AMP
ASSIGN
R L R L R L R L
Front A Bi-Amp
FR-A FL-A FR-B FL-B C SR SL
FR FL
Front B Bi-Amp
FR FL
FL-A/FR-A Bi-Amp
connection
FL-B/FR-B Bi-Amp
connection
FL
SW C FR
SL SR
Main zone
5.1ch
FL/FR
Bi-Amp
Front A Bi-Amp
Amp Assign mode:
n Amp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker
terminals
Front B Bi-Amp

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 62 2007/06/20 8:58:34
Multi-zone Operations
Turning the Power On and Off
GOperation on the main unitH
Press <ZONE2 ON/OFF> or <ZONE3 ON/OFF> for the zone to be operated.
When the power turns on, the multi-zone indicator ( or )
lights on the display.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode you want to operate, press [ON] or [OFF].
Selecting the Input Source
GOperation on the main unitH
q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted.
w Turn <SOURCE SELECT>.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode you want to operate, press [SOURCE SELECT].
Adjusting the Volume
GOperation on the main unitH
q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted.
w Turn <VOLUME> to adjust.
GOperation on the remote control unitH
In the zone mode whose volume you want to adjust, press [VOLUME].
– – –
–70dB
~
–40dB
~
+18dB[Variable range]
The volume can be adjusted when menu “Manual Setup” “Zone
Setup” “(select the zone)” “Volume Level” is set to “VAR”. The
volume can be increased up to the value set at menu “Manual Setup”
“Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Volume Limit” (vpage 30).
<ZONE2/3 / RECSELECT>
<ZONE2 ON/OFF>
<ZONE3 ON/OFF>
SOURCE SELECT
VOLUME
Turning off the Sound Temporarily
In the zone mode for which you want to mute the sound, press
[MUTE].
The sound is reduced to the level set at menu “Manual Setup” “Zone
Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Mute Level” (vpage 30).
To cancel, either adjust the volume or press [MUTE] again.
The setting is canceled when the zone’s power is turned off.
The source selected for ZONE2 is also output from the recording
output connectors.
NOTE
When the input source to which the digital input connectors
(OPTICAL/COAXIAL) are assigned is selected in ZONE2 or ZONE3,
playback is only possible if the digital signal being input is in PCM
(2-channel) format.
Digital audio signals input from the HDMI connectors cannot be
played in multi-zone.
When certain digital signals are being input, noise may be output
from the ZONE2 and ZONE3 audio output connectors.
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
About the button names in these explanations
< > : Buttons on the main unit
[ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit
Button name only:
Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit
[OFF]
[ON]
[MUTE]
VOLUME
SOURCE SELECT
(Sub remote control unit)
[MUTE]
SOURCE
SELECT
[ON]
[OFF]
VOLUME
[ AMP]
[ON]
[OFF]
(ZONE3
mode)
(ZONE2
mode)
(Main remote control unit)
AVR2808CIEU.indd 63 2007/06/20 8:58:35
Surround back speakers
Sound positioning directly to the rear can be achieved easily by adding
a surround back speaker to a 5.1-channel system.
In addition, the acoustic image extending between the sides and the
rear is narrowed, thus greatly improving the expression of the surround
signals for sounds moving from the sides to the back and from the
front to the point directly behind the listening position.
'- $
48
'3
43DI4-DI
Change of positioning and acoustic image
with 5.1-channel systems
Movement of acoustic image from SR to SL
'- $
48
'3
4-DI 43DI
4#DI
Change of positioning and acoustic image
with 6.1-channel systems
Movement of acoustic image from
SR to SB to SL
In addition to sources recorded in 6.1-channels, the surround effect of
conventional 2- to 5.1-channel sources can also be enhanced.
Number of surround back speakers
We recommend using 2 speakers.
When using dipolar speakers in particular, be sure to use 2 speakers.
Placement of the surround left and right channels
when using surround back speakers
We recommend installing the speakers for the surround “Land “R”
channels a bit forward.
Examples of speaker layouts
Below we introduce examples of speaker layouts. Refer to these to
arrange your speakers according to their type and how you want to
use them.
G1H Using surround back speaker(s)
q When mainly playing movies
Recommended when your surround speakers are single or 2-way
speakers.
Surround back speakers
Subwoofer
Surround
speakers
Monitor
Center speaker
Front speakers
60°
60°
Surround
speaker
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
Point slightly
downwards
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H
2 to 3 feet /
60 to 90 cm
Other Information
About Speaker Installation
w Setting for primarily watching movies using diffusion type
speakers for the surround speakers
For the greatest sense of surround sound envelopment, diffuse
radiation speakers such as bipolar types, or dipolar types, provide
a wider dispersion than is possible to obtain from a direct radiating
speaker (monopolar). Place these speakers at either side of the
prime listening position, mounted above ear level.
Surround
speakers
60°
Surround back speakers
Surround
speaker
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
2 to 3 feet /
Point slightly
downwards
60 to 90 cm
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H
Path of the surround sound from the
speakers to the listening position
e When playing movies and music
Center speaker
Front speakers
Subwoofer
Monitor
45° ~ 60°
Surround back
speaker
Surround
speaker
Surround
speaker
Surround back
speaker
Front speaker
Point slightly
downwards
2 to 3 feet /
60 to 90 cm
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 64 2007/06/20 8:58:37
G2H When not using surround back speakers
Subwoofer
Surround speakers
Monitor
Center speaker
Front speakers
60°
120°
2 to 3 feet /
60 to 90 cm
Front speaker
Surround speaker
G
As seen from above
H G
As seen from the side
H
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital is a multichannel digital signal format developed by Dolby
Laboratories.
A total of 5.1-channels are played: 3 front channels (“FL, “FR” and
“C”), 2 surround channels (“SL” and “SR”) and the “LFE” channel for
low frequencies.
Because of this, there is no crosstalk between channels and a realistic
sound field with a “three-dimensional” feeling (sense of distance,
movement and positioning) is achieved.
A real, overpowering sense of presence is achieved when playing
movie sources in AV rooms as well.
Surround
Dolby Surround
The AVR-2808CI is equipped with a digital signal processing circuit
that lets you play program sources in the surround mode to achieve
the same sense of presence as in a movie theater.
Dolby Pro Logic g
Dolby Pro Logic g is a matrix decoding technology developed by Dolby
Laboratories.
Regular music such as that on CDs is encoded into 5-channels to
achieve an excellent surround effect.
The surround channel signals are converted into stereo and full band
signals (with a frequency response of 20 Hz to 20 kHz or greater)
to create a “three-dimensional” sound image offering a rich sense of
presence for all stereo sources.
Dolby Digital Plus
Dolby Digital Plus is an improved Dolby Digital signal format that is
compatible with up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound and also
improves sound quality thanks to extra data bit rate performance. It
is upwardly compatible with conventional Dolby Digital, so it offers
greater flexibility in response to the source signal and the conditions
of the playback equipment.
Dolby TrueHD
Dolby TrueHD is a high definition audio technology developed by Dolby
Laboratories, using lossless coding technology to faithfully reproduce
the sound of the studio master.
This format is compatible with a maximum sampling frequency of 96
kHz and up to 7.1-channels, so it is used for applications particularly
prioritizing sound quality.
Dolby Pro Logic gx
Dolby Pro Logic gx is a further improved version of the Dolby Pro Logic
g matrix decoding technology.
Audio signals recorded in 2-channels are decoded to achieve a natural
sound with up to 7.1-channels.
There are 3 modes: “Music” suited for playing music, “Cinema”
suited for playing movies, and “Gamewhich is optimized for playing
games.
b Sources recorded in Dolby Surround
Sources recorded in Dolby Surround are indicated with the following
logo marks.
Dolby Surround support mark :
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
“Dolby”, “Pro Logic” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of
Dolby Laboratories.
DTS Surround
DTS Digital Surround
DTS Digital Surround is the standard digital surround format of DTS,
Inc., compatible with a sampling frequency of 44.1 or 48 kHz and up
to 5.1-channels of digital discrete surround sound.
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio
DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is an improved version of the
conventional DTS, DTS-ES and DTS 96/24 signals formats, compatible
with sampling frequencies of 96 or 48 kHz and up to 7.1-channels
of discrete digital sound. High data bit rate performance provides
high quality sound. This format is fully compatible with conventional
products, including conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel
data.
DTS-HD Master Audio
DTS-HD Master Audio is DTS, Inc’s lossless audio format compatible
with up to 96 kHz/7.1-channels. The lossless audio coding technology
faithfully reproduces the sound of the studio master. It is fully
compatible with conventional products, including conventional DTS
digital surround 5.1-channel data.
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1
DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format
adding a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound.
Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible
according to the decoder.
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1
DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format
inserting a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround
sound through matrix encoding. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel
audio signals is also possible according to the decoder.
DTS NEO:6™ Surround
DTS NEO:6™ is a matrix decoding technology for achieving 6.1-
channel surround playback with 2-channel sources. It includes “DTS
NEO:6 CINEMA” suited for playing movies and “DTS NEO:6 MUSIC”
suited for playing music.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 65 2007/06/20 8:58:37
DTS 96/24
DTS 96/24 is a digital audio format enabling high sound quality
playback in 5.1-channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz and 24
bit quantization on DVD-Video.
Neural Surround™, a breakthrough in audio technology, will bring the
excitement of surround music to more of America’s listening audience.
It provides the rich envelopment and discrete image detail of surround
sound in a format 100 % compatible with stereo. With superior
spectral resolution and channel separation, Neural Surround™ draws
the brains attention to sonic details in musical instruments, vocals,
and ambience that are typically masked by other playback systems.
This allows the listener to fully experience the richness and subtleties
in recorded performance as never before. As the chosen format for XM
Satellite Radios new XM HD surround programming, Neural Surround
will help deliver more surround music to more listeners than any other
broadcast format. XM Satellite Radio will be the first radio company to
broadcast surround sound on the radio 24 hours a day and will offer
three channels fully dedicated to Neural Surround™ music. This alone
will amount to more than 25,000 hours of Neural Surround™ music
each year.
Neural Surround
This product is manufactured under license from Neural Audio
Corporation.
D&M Holdings Inc. hereby grants the user a non-exclusive,
nontransferable, limited license right exercisable to use the NA
SURROUND Technology and other US and World Wide Patents
Pending technology.
“Neural” and “Neural Audio and “Neural Surround” are
trademarks of Neural Audio Corporation. All Rights Reserved.
Audyssey MultEQ XT is a technology designed to provide the optimum
listening environment for multiple listeners within the listening
area. Test data collected from multiple listening points is analyzed
comprehensively and equalization that improves the sound quality for
the entire listening area is performed.
Audyssey MultEQ XT not only corrects frequency response problems
in large listening areas, it also fully automates the surround system
setup.
For a detailed description, see page 24.
Audyssey MultEQ XT
Audyssey MultEQ XT is a trademark of Audyssey Laboratories. It is
licensed under US and National Patent Applications 20030235318
and 10/700,220. Additional U.S. and Foreign Patents pending.
MultEQ and the Audyssey MultEQ logo are trademarks of
Audyssey Laboratories, Inc.. All rights reserved.
AL24 Processing Plus
AL24 Processing for All Channels
DENON has further developed its proprietary AL24 Processing, an
analog waveform reproduction technology, to support the 192-kHz
sampling frequency of DVD-Audio. AL24 Processing Plus, thoroughly
suppresses quantization noise associated with D/A conversion of
LPCM signals to reproduce the low-level signals with optimum clarity
that will bring out all the delicate nuances of the music.
Equipped foe not only front left and right channels but also for the
surround left and right, center and subwoofer channels.
Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s: 5,451,942;
5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535 & other
U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS is a registered
trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and DTS-HD
Master Audio are trademarks of DTS, Inc.
©
1996-2007 DTS, Inc.
All Rights Reserved.
HDMI
(High-Definition Multimedia Interface)
HDMI is a digital interface standard for next generation TVs based
on DVI (Digital Visual Interface) standards and optimized for use in
consumer equipment.
Non-compressed digital video and multi-channel audio signals are
transmitted with a single connection.
HDMI is also compatible with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Contents
Protection), a technology for protecting copyrights that encrypts digital
video signals in the same was as with DVI.
“HDMI”, “HDMI logoand “High-Definition Multimedia Interface
are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing
LLC.
Deep Color
Eliminates on-screen color banding, for smooth tonal transitions and
subtle gradations between colors.
Enables increased contrast ratio.
Can represent many times more shades of gray between black and
white.
At 30-bit pixel depth, a four times improvement would be the minimum,
and the typical improvement would be eight times or more.
xvYCC
Next-generation “xvYCC” color space supports 1.8 times as many
colors as existing HDTV signals.
Lets HDTVs display colors more accurately.
Enables displays with natural, vivid colors.
Lip Sync
Because consumer electronics devices are using increasingly
complex digital signal processing to enhance the clarity and detail of
the content, synchronization of video and audio in user devices has
become a greater challenge and could potentially require complex end-
user adjustments. HDMI 1.3 incorporates an automatic video/audio
synching capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization
automatically with total accuracy.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 66 2007/06/20 8:58:38
Surround mode
Signals and adjustability in the different modes
Channel output Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses)
Front L/R Center
Surround
L/R
Surround
Back L/R
Subwoofer
D. COMP
z
1
LFE
z
2
AFDM
z
1
SB CH OUT
CINEMA
EQ.
PURE DIRECT, DIRECT
S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A A
DSD DIRECT
S A A A A A A A A A
DSD MULTI DIRECT
S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) A S A
MULTI CH DIRECT
S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S A
STEREO
S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A A
EXT. IN
S D D D D A A A A A
MULTI CH IN
S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S A
WIDE SCREEN
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S S (OFF)
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx S D D D D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE1)
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g S D D A D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE2)
DTS NEO:6
S D D D D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE1)
DOLBY DIGITAL
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S S (OFF)
DTS SURROUND
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S S (OFF)
neural
S D D D D A A A S A
7CH STEREO
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
SUPER STADIUM
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
ROCK ARENA
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
JAZZ CLUB
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
CLASSIC CONCERT
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
MONO MOVIE
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
VIDEO GAME
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
MATRIX
S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A
VIRTURL
S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A A
S : Enable
A : Unable
NOTE1 : This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter”
“Surround Parameter” “MODE” is set to “CINEMA
(vpage 38).
NOTE2 : This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter”
“Surround Parameter” – “MODE” is set to “CINEMA” or
“PL” (vpage 38).
NOTE:
z
1 : When playing Dolby Digital and DTS signals.
z
2 : When playing Dolby Digital, DTS, DVD-Audio and Super
Audio CD.
S : Signal / Adjustable
A : No signal / Not adjustable
D : Turned on or off by speaker configuration setting
Surround Modes and Parameters

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 67 2007/06/20 8:58:39
Surround mode
Signals and adjustability in the different modes
Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses)
MODE ROOM SIZE LEVEL DELAY TIME Subwoofer
PRO LOGIC g/gx MUSIC mode only
NEO:6 MUSIC
mode only
EXT. IN only
Tone Control Night Mode Room EQ RESTORER
PANORAMA DIMENSION
CENTER
WIDTH
CENTER
IMAGE
SUBWOOFER
ATT.
PURE DIRECT, DIRECT
A A A A S A A A A A A S (OFF) S (NOTE5) S
DSD DIRECT
A A A A S A A A A A A A S (NOTE5) A
DSD MULTI DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A S (NOTE5) A
MULTI CH DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A S (OFF) S (OFF) A
STEREO
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
EXT. IN
A A A A A A A A A S A A A A
MULTI CH IN
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A
WIDE SCREEN
A A S (ON, 10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx S (CINEMA) A A A A S (OFF) S (3) S (3) A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g S (CINEMA) A A A A S (OFF) S (3) S (3) A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
DTS NEO:6
S (CINEMA) A A A A A A A S (0.3) A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
DOLBY DIGITAL
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A
DTS SURROUND
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A
neural
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
7CH STEREO
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
SUPER STADIUM
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (NOTE3) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
ROCK ARENA
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (NOTE4) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
JAZZ CLUB
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
CLASSIC CONCERT
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
MONO MOVIE
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
VIDEO GAME
A S (medium) S (10) A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
MATRIX
A A A S (30 ms) A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
VIRTURL
A A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S
S : Signal / Adjustable
A : No signal / Not adjustable
D : Turned on or off by speaker configuration setting
S : Adjustable
A : Not adjustable
NOTE3 : BASS +6 dB, TREBLE 0 dB
NOTE4 : BASS +6 dB, TREBLE +4 dB
NOTE5 : Can be used according to the “Direct Mode” setting.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 68 2007/06/20 8:58:39
Button
Note
Input signals
ANALOG
LINEAR
PCM
DTS DOLBY DIGITAL DVD-AUDIO Super Audio CD
Surround mode
DTS ES
DSCRT
(With Flag)
DTS ES
MTRX
(With Flag)
DTS
(5.1ch)
DTS
96/24
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With no
Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(5.1/5/4ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(4/3ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(2ch)
DVD-
Audio
(multi ch)
DVD-
Audio
(2ch)
DSD
(multi ch)
DSD
(2ch)
STANDARD
DTS SURROUND
DTS ES DSCRT6.1
z
1
A A F D A A A A A A A A A A A A
DTS ES MTRX6.1
z
1
A A A F D A A A A A A A A A A A
DTS SURROUND
A A S S F A A A A A A A A A A
DTS 96/24
A A A A A F A A A A A A A A A
DTS + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A S S S S A A A A A A A A A
DTS + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A S S S S A A A A A A A A A
DTS + NEO:6
z
1
A A A S S S A A A A A A A A A
DTS NEO:6 CINEMA
S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DTS NEO:6 MUSIC
S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY SURROUND
DOLBY DIGITAL EX
z
1
A A A A A A S S S S A A A A A
DOLBY DIGITAL
A A A A A A S F F F A A A A A
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A F D S S S A A A A A
DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A S S S S A A A A A
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx CINEMA S S A A A A A A A A F A S A S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx MUSIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx GAME S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g CINEMA S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g MUSIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC g GAME S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
DOLBY PRO LOGIC
S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S
neural
S S A A A A A A A A A A S A A
MULTI CH IN
MULTI CH IN
A A A A A A A A A A A F A F A
MULTI IN + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
MULTI IN + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
MULTI CH IN 7.1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A A A
F : Mode selectable in initial status
D : Mode fixed when AFDM” is ON”
S : Selectable mode
A : Non-selectable mode
NOTE:
z
1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None.
z
2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None.
Differences in Surround Mode Names Depending on the Input Signals

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 69 2007/06/20 8:58:41
Button
Note
Input signals
ANALOG
LINEAR
PCM
DTS DOLBY DIGITAL DVD-AUDIO Super Audio CD
Surround mode
DTS ES
DSCRT
(With Flag)
DTS ES
MTRX
(With Flag)
DTS
(5.1ch)
DTS
96/24
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL EX
(With no
Flag)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(5.1/5/4ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(4/3ch)
DOLBY
DIGITAL
(2ch)
DVD-
Audio
(multi
ch)
DVD-
Audio
(2ch)
DSD
(multi
ch)
DSD
(2ch)
DIRECT
DIRECT
S S S S S S S S S S S A S A S
DSD DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A A A S
DSD MULTI DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A A S A
MULTI CH DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M DIRECT + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M DIRECT + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M DIRECT 7.1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A A A
PURE DIRECT
PURE DIRECT
S S S S S S S S S S S A S A S
DSD PURE DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A A A A S
DSD MULTI PURE
A A A A A A A A A A A A A S A
MULTI CH PURE DIRECT
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M PURE D + PLgx CINEMA
z
2
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M PURE D + PLgx MUSIC
z
1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A
M CH PURE DIRECT 7.1
A A A A A A A A A A A S A A A
DSP SIMULATION
7CH STEREO
z
3
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
WIDE SCREEN
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
SUPER STADIUM
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
ROCK ARENA
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
JAZZ CLUB
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
CLASSIC CONCERT
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
MONO MOVIE
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
VIDEO GAME
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
MATRIX
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
VIRTUAL
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
STEREO
STEREO
F F S S S S S S S S S S F S F
F : Mode selectable in initial status
S : Selectable mode
A : Non-selectable mode
NOTE :
z
1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None.
z
2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None.
z
3: If the surround back speaker setup is set to “None, then “5CH STEREO” is displayed.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 70 2007/06/20 8:58:42
Relationship Between Video Signals and Monitor Output
Video convert
Input signals MONITOR OUT
HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO
ON
A A A A A A A A
A A A S
VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO
A A S A
S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A A S S
S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (1080p) A A A
COMPONENT
A A
A S (480p ~ 720p) A A
COMPONENT COMPONENT
A A
A S (480i / 576i) A A
COMPONENT COMPONENT COMPONENT COMPONENT
A S (1080p) A S
VIDEO COMPONENT
z
1 VIDEO VIDEO
A S (480p ~ 720p) A S
COMPONENT
z
1 COMPONENT
z
1
A
z
3
VIDEO
A S (480i / 576i) A S
COMPONENT
z
1 COMPONENT
z
1 COMPONENT VIDEO
A S (1080p) S A
S-VIDEO COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480p ~ 720p) S A
COMPONENT
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480i / 576i) S A
COMPONENT
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (1080p) S S
S-VIDEO COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480p ~ 720p) S S
COMPONENT
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
A S (480i / 576i) S S
COMPONENT
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S A A A
HDMI
A A A
S A A S
HDMI
z
1 VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO
S A S A
HDMI
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S A S S
HDMI
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (Other than 480i / 576i) A A
HDMI COMPONENT
A A
S S (480i / 576i) A A
HDMI COMPONENT COMPONENT COMPONENT
S S (1080p) A S
HDMI
z
1 COMPONENT
z
1 VIDEO VIDEO
S S (480p ~ 720p) A S
HDMI
z
1 COMPONENT
z
1
A
z
3
VIDEO
S S (480i / 576i) A S
HDMI
z
1 COMPONENT
z
1 COMPONENT VIDEO
S S (Other than 480i / 576i) S A
HDMI
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (480i / 576i) S A
HDMI
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (Other than 480i / 576i) S S
HDMI
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S S (480i / 576i) S S
HDMI
z
2 COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO S-VIDEO
S : Signal input
A : No signal
480p ~ 720p: 480p / 576p / 1080i / 720p
A : Not output
z
1 : On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output.
z
2 : On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output.
z
3 : Video signals are output when the analog to HDMI convert function is set
to OFF”.
COMPONENT :
On-screen display only displayed for MENU and PARA buttons
on the main remote control unit.
HDMI : The on-screen display is displayed when the analog to HDMI
convert function is set to ON”.
: Video signals are not output when the analog to HDMI convert
function is set to OFF”.
The main zone video conversion function is compatible with the following format: NTSC, PAL, SECAM, NTSC4.43, PAL-N, PAL-M and PAL-60.
When SECAM signals of video input are up-converted, the signals are output in PAL format from the S-Video connector.
When the input signal is a component 1080i or 720p signal, the signal upconverted to HDMI is output with that resolution or 1080p.
When the input signal is a video, S-Video or component 480i, 480p, 576i or 576p signals, the signal up-converted to HDMI is output according to
the setting made at “Resolution” under “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Video Setup” (vpage 28).
• Signals up-converted to HDMI are output to the HDMI monitor with the resolution at which they are input.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 71 2007/06/20 8:58:42
Video convert
S-VIDEO
MONITOR OUT
Input signals MONITOR OUT
HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO
OFF
A A A A A A A A
A A A S A A A
VIDEO
A A S A A A
S-VIDEO
A
Used
A A S S A A
S-VIDEO VIDEO
z
2
Not used
A A S S A A
VIDEO
A S A A A
COMPONENT
A A
A S A S A
COMPONENT
z
1
A
VIDEO
A S S A A
COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO
A
Used
A S S S A
COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO VIDEO
z
2
Not used
A S S S A
COMPONENT
z
1 VIDEO
S A A A
HDMI
A A A
S A A S
HDMI
A A
VIDEO
S A S A
HDMI
A
S-VIDEO
A
Used
S A S S
HDMI
A
S-VIDEO VIDEO
z
2
Not used
S A S S
HDMI
A
VIDEO
S S A A
HDMI COMPONENT
A A
S S A S
HDMI COMPONENT
z
1
A
VIDEO
S S S A
HDMI COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO
A
Used
S S S S
HDMI COMPONENT
z
2 S-VIDEO VIDEO
z
2
Not used
S S S S
HDMI COMPONENT
z
1 VIDEO
S : Signal input
A : No signal
A : Not output
z
1 : On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output.
z
2 : On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output.
COMPONENT :
On-screen display only displayed for MENU and PARA buttons
on the main remote control unit.
HDMI : The on-screen display is displayed when the analog to HDMI
convert function is set to ON”.
Input
Monitor out
S-VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO
A A A
A S S (VIDEO)
S A S (S-VIDEO)
S S S (S-VIDEO)
S : Output present
A : No output
S : Signal present
A : No signal
n ZONE2 monitor out

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 72 2007/06/20 8:58:43
If a problem should arise, first check the following:
1. Are the connections correct?
2. Is the set being operated as described in the owners manual?
3. Are the other components operating properly?
If this unit does not operate properly, check the items listed in the table below. Should the problem persist,
there may be a malfunction.
In this case, disconnect the power immediately and contact your store of purchase.
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
Power does not
turn on, or turns
off directly after it
was turned on.
Connection of the power cord is
faulty.
Check that the power plugs are
securely inserted into the AVR-
2808CI’s AC inlets and the wall
power outlet.
20
No sound is
produced from
speakers.
Connection with the input
devices or connection of the
speaker cables is faulty.
Device you want to play and set
input source do not match.
Master volume is turned too
low.
Mute mode is set.
Headphones are connected.
No digital signals are being
input.
The connectors to which the
digital inputs are assigned and
the settable input modes do not
match.
Check the connections.
Select an appropriate input
source.
Adjust the master volume to an
appropriate level.
Cancel the mute mode.
Disconnect the headphones.
Select an input source for which
the digital input setting has been
made.
Set the input mode.
9
43
43
43
43
35
34
Display is off. The “Dimmer” setting is set to
OFF”.
The PURE DIRECT mode is set.
Set to something other than
OFF”.
Set a surround mode other than
the PURE DIRECT mode.
32
38
“DOLBY DIGITAL
indicator does not
appear on display.
DVD player’s digital audio output
setting is not proper.
Check the DVD player’s audio
output setting. For details, read
the DVD player’s operating
instructions.
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
Power turns off
suddenly and
power indicator
flashes red.
Protection circuit activated due
to rise of internal temperature.
Core wires of two speakers are
touching each other or a core
wire is sticking out of the terminal
and touching the set’s rear panel,
activating the protection circuit.
Speakers with an impedance
other than specified are being
used.
Set is damaged.
Turn off the power, wait for the
set to fully cool down, then turn
the power back on.
Place the set in a well-ventilated
place.
First unplug the power cord,
then twist the core wires tightly
or terminate the speaker cables,
then reconnect.
Use speakers with the specified
impedance.
Turn off the power and contact a
DENON service center.
10
10
10
10
GGeneralH
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
Set does not work
properly when
remote control
unit operated.
Batteries are worn.
You are operating outside of the
specified range.
Obstacle between main unit and
remote control unit.
The batteries are not inserted in
the proper direction, as indicated
by the polarity marks in the
battery compartment.
The set’s remote control sensor
is exposed to strong light (direct
sunlight, inverter type fluorescent
bulb light, etc.).
The remote ID of the main unit
and remote control unit do not
match.
Replace with new batteries.
Operate within the specified
range.
Remove the obstacle.
Insert the batteries in the
proper direction, following the
polarity marks in the battery
compartment.
Move the set to a place in which
the remote control sensor will
not be exposed to strong light.
Set the same remote IDs for the
main unit and remote control
unit.
3
3
3
3
3
54
GRemote Control UnitH
Troubleshooting
0
Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 73 2007/06/20 8:58:43
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
No sound is
produced from
center speaker.
Monaural source (monitor, AM
station, etc.) being played in
STANDARD mode.
The mode is set to something
other than “STANDARD”.
37
No sound
is produced
from surround
speakers.
The surround mode is set to
“STEREO, “DIRECT” or “PURE
DIRECT”.
Set to a surround playback
mode.
36, 37
No sound is
produced from
surround back
speaker.
The surround back speaker’s
power amplifier is assigned to a
different channel.
Surround back speaker setting is
set to “None.
Surround mode not set to a mode
for 6.1- or 7.1-channel playback.
Check the setting and change it
as necessary.
Set to something other than
“None.
Select a surround playback
mode.
31
26
36, 37
No sound is
produced from
subwoofer.
Subwoofer’s power not turned
on.
The “Subwoofer” setting at
“Speaker configuration” is set to
“No.
The subwoofer is not properly
connected.
The subwoofers volume is
turned off.
Turn on the subwoofers power.
Set to “Yes”.
Check the connections.
Adjust the subwoofer’s volume
to an appropriate level.
26
9
50
No test tones are
produced when
main remote
control unit’s TEST
TONE button is
pressed.
Surround mode not set to
“STANDARD”.
Set to the STANDARD mode. 37
DTS sound is not
output.
DVD player’s audio output setting
is not set to bitstream.
DVD player is not compatible
with DTS sound playback.
The AVR-2808CI’s “Decode
Mode” setting is set to “PCM”.
Set the DVD player. For details,
refer to the DVD player’s
operating instructions.
Use a DTS-compatible player.
Set to the Auto or “DTS”
mode.
34
HDMI audio
signals are not
output from
speakers.
The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI
Setup” “HDMI Audio Setup”
“HDMI Audio Out” setting is
set to “TV”.
Set to “AMP”. 27
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
No sound is
output from
the monitor
connected
with HDMI
connections.
The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI
Setup” “HDMI Audio Setup”
“HDMI Audio Out” setting is
set to AMP”.
Set to “TV”. 27
GAudioH
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
No picture
appears.
The connections between the
AVR-2808CI and monitor are
faulty.
The monitors input setting is
wrong.
PURE DIRECT mode is set.
The player is connected using the
component input connectors, the
monitor is connected using the
video (yellow) or S-Video output
connectors.
Check the connections.
Set properly.
Cancel the PURE DIRECT mode.
High definition (1080i/720p) and
progressive (480p/576p) video
signals are not down-converted.
Set the player to interlace
(480i/576i) signals.
11 ~ 20
38
No picture
appears
with HDMI
connections.
The connections to the HDMI
connectors are faulty.
HDMI input setting is improper.
The monitor is not compatible
with copyright protection
(HDCP).
The HDMI format of the player
and monitor do not match.
Check the connections.
Check the HDMI input setting.
Connect a monitor that is
compatible with copyright
protection (HDCP).
Match the HDMI format of the
player and monitor.
11
35
11
11
Picture cannot be
recorded.
Input source does not match
recorder’s video connection
connector (video or S-Video).
The video conversion function
does not work for the REC
OUT connectors. Match the
input source and recorder
connections.
15
DVDs cannot be
copied on a VCR.
This is not a malfunction. Most
movie software includes copy
prevention signals and cannot be
copied.
GVideoH

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 74 2007/06/20 8:58:44
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
iPod cannot be
played.
The input source assigned to
“iPod dock” is not selected.
Cable is not properly connected.
Control Dock for iPod’s AC
adapter is not connected to
power outlet.
Switch to the input source
assigned at “iPod dock”.
Reconnect.
Plug the Control Dock for iPod’s
AC adapter into a power outlet.
36
14
GiPodH
Symptom Cause Countermeasure Page
”CHECK
ANTENNA” is
displayed in the
XM mode.
AVR-2808CI’s XM connector and
the XM Mini-Tuner and Home
Dock is not properly connected.
Check that the connections are
correct.
18
”NO SIGNAL” is
displayed in the
XM mode.
The signal cannot be received. Reposition your XM Mini-Tuner
and Home Dock antenna.
46
”OFF AIR” is
displayed in the
XM mode.
The selected channel is not
currently broadcasting.
Select another channel. 45, 46
Receiving only
XM channels 0
and 1.
The XM Tuner is not activated. Contact XM Radio. 45
GXM Satellite RadioH

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 75 2007/06/20 8:58:44

Specifications
n
Audio section
Power amplifer
Rated output:
Front (A, B):
110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Center:
110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround:
110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Surround Back:
110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.)
140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.)
Dynamic power:
120 W x 2ch (8 Ω/ohms)
170 W x 2ch (4 Ω/ohms)
Output terminals: Front: A or B
6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
A + B
8 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
Center, Surround, Surr. Back: 6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms
Analog
Input sensitivity / Input impedance:
200 mV / 47 kΩ/kohms
Frequency response:
10 Hz ~ 100 kHz — +1, –3 dB (DIRECT mode)
S/N:
102 dB (DIRECT mode)
Distortion:
0.005 % (20 Hz ~ 20 kHz) (DIRECT mode)
Rated output:
1.2 V
Digital
D/A output:
Rated output — 2 V (at 0 dB playback)
Total harmonic distortion — 0.008 % (1 kHz, at 0 dB)
S /N ratio — 102 dB
Dynamic range — 96 dB
Digital input:
Format — Digital audio interface
Phono equalizer (PHONO input — REC OUT)
Input sensitivity:
2.5 mV
RIAA deviation:
±1 dB (20 Hz to 20 kHz)
S/N:
74 dB (A weighting, with 5 mV input)
Rated output:
150 mV
Distortion factor:
0.03 % (1 kHz, 3 V)
n
Video section
Standard video terminals
Input / output level and impedance:
1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB
S-Video terminals
Input / output level and impedance:
Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
C (color) signal — 0.286 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB
Color component video terminal
Input / output level and impedance:
Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
P
B / CB signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
P
R / CR signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms
Frequency response:
5 Hz ~ 100 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to OFF”)
n
Tuner section [FM] [AM]
(note: µV at 75 Ω/ohms, 0 dBf = 1 x 10
-15
W)
Receiving Range: 87.5 MHz ~ 107.9 MHz 520 kHz ~ 1710 kHz
Usable Sensitivity: 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf) 18 µV
50 dB Quieting Sensitivity: MONO 1.6 µV (15.3 dBf)
STEREO 23 µV (38.5 dBf)
S/N (IHF-A): MONO 77 dB
STEREO 72 dB
Total harmonic Distortion (at 1 kHz): MONO 0.15 %
STEREO 0.3 %
n
General
Power supply: AC 120 V, 60 Hz
Power consumption:
6.0 A
0.3 W (Standby)
Maximum external dimensions:
434 (W) x 171 (H) x 420 (D) mm (17-3/32” x 6-47/64” x 16-17/32”)
Weight: 12.8 kg (28 lbs 3.5 oz)
n
Main remote control unit (RC-1068)
Batteries: LR6/AA Type (two batteries)
Maximum external dimensions:
63 (W) x 238 (H) x 31 (D) mm (2-31/64” x 9-3/8” x 1-7/32”)
Weight: 190 g (Approx 6.7 oz) (including batteries)
n
Sub remote control unit (RC-1071)
Batteries: R03/AAA Type (two batteries)
Maximum external dimensions:
54 (W) x 115 (H) x 23 (D) mm (2-1/8” x 4-17/32” x 29/32”)
Weight: 80 g (Approx 2.8 oz) (including batteries)
z For purposes of improvement, specifications and design are subject to change without notice.

Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting
AVR2808CIEU.indd 76 2007/06/20 8:58:44
Denon Amp
D
Denon 81001, 82001, 83001, 84001
Denon Tuner
D
Denon (Analog) 52863, 52795, 52800, 52805
Denon (XM Radio) 52864, 52812, 52813, 52814
Denon iPod
D
Denon 72815, 72816, 72817, 72818
Cable
A
A-Mark 00008, 00144
ABC 00237, 00003, 00008
Accuphase 00003
Acorn 00237
Action 00237
Active 00237
ADB 01230
Aichi Denshi 01512
Americast 00899
Amstrad 01222
Archer 00237
Auna 01230
Austar 00276
B
BCC 00276
Bell South 00899
Bestlink 00303
Birmingham Cable
Communications
00276
British Telecom 00003
C
Cable & Wireless 01068
Century 00008
Coship 01462
D
Daehan 00778
Daeryung 01877, 00877, 00477, 00008
Digeo 01187
Director 00476
DX Antenna 01500
E
Emerson 00303
Encon 00008
F
Fosgate 00276
Foxtel 01222
France Telecom 00817
Freebox 01482
Fujitsu 01497
G
Galaxi 00008
GE 00237, 00144
Gehua 00476
General Instrument 00476, 00810, 00276, 00003
Gibralter 00003
GNI 01466
GoldStar 00144
H
Hitachi 00003, 00008
Hongtian Jiangsu 01462
Hwalin 00303
I
Insight 00476, 00810
J
Jerrold 00476, 00810, 00276, 00003
Jiuzhou 01445
K
KNC 00008
L
LG 00144
M
Macab 00817
Madritel 01230
Maspro 01510
Matav 01082
Memorex 00000
Mitsubishi 00003
Motorola
01376, 00476, 00810, 00276,
01187
MS 00303
N
NEC 01496
Noos 00817
Nova Vision 00008
Novaplex 00008
NTL 00276, 00003, 01060, 01068
O
Oak 00303
Ono 01068
Optus 00276, 01060
P
Pace
01877, 00877, 00237, 00008,
01060, 01068, 01577
Panasonic 00000, 00008, 00144, 01488
Paragon 00000, 00008, 00525
Penney 00000
Philips 01305, 00317, 00817
Pioneer
01877, 00877, 00144, 00533,
01500
Pulsar 00000
PVP Stereo Visual
Matrix
00003
Q
Quasar 00000
R
RadioShack 00303
Regal 00276
Runco 00000
S
Sagem 00817
Salora 00000
Samsung
00003, 00000, 00144, 00778,
00840, 01060, 01666
Scientific Atlanta
01877, 00877, 00477, 00237,
00003, 00000, 00008, 01510
Skyworth 01464
Sony 01006, 01460
Sprucer 00144
Starcom 00003
StarHub 00276
Sumitomo 01500, 01504
Supercable 00276
T
Taihan 00778
TCL 01445
Telewest 01068
Time Warner cable 01877
TongKook 00840
Torx 00003
Toshiba 00000, 01509
Trans PX 00276, 00303
TS 00003, 00303
U
United Cable 00276, 00003
US Electronics 00276, 00003, 00008
V
Videoway 00000
Visiopass 00817
Z
Zenith 00000, 00525, 00899
Cable/PVR Combination
A
Americast 00899
D
Digeo 01187
F
Freebox 01482
G
General Instrument 00810
J
Jerrold 00810
M
Motorola 01376, 00810, 01187
P
Pace 01877, 00237
Pioneer 01877, 00877
S
Scientific Atlanta 01877, 00877
Sony 01006
Supercable 00276
T
Time Warner cable 01877
Z
Zenith 00899
CD Player
A
Acoustic Research 40420
Advantage 40032
Aiwa 40157
Arcam 40157
Audio Research 40157
Audiolab 40157
Audiomeca 40157
Audioton 40157
AVI 40157
B
Balanced Audio
Technology
40157
Burmester 40420
Bush 40388
C
Cairn 40157
California Audio Labs
40029, 40303
Cambridge 40157
Cambridge Audio 40157
Cambridge
Soundworks
40157
Carver 40157, 40179
CDC 40420
CEC 40420
Copland 40393
Curtis Mathes 40032
Cyrus 40157
D
Denon
40873, 40003, 40766,
[42867]
z
, 42868
DKK 40000
DMX Electronics 40157
Dual 40003
Dynaco 40157
Dynamic Bass 40179
F
Fisher 40000, 40179
G
Garrard 40393, 40420
Genexxa 40000, 40032, 40037, 40179
Goldmund 40157
Grundig 40157
H
Hafler 40173
Harman/Kardon 40100, 40157, 40173
Hitachi 40032
I
Inkel 40157
Integra 40101
J
Jerrold 40003
JVC 40032, 40072
K
Kenwood
40681, 40000, 40029, 40157,
40028, 40037, 40036, 40190
KLH 41318
Krell 40157
L
Linn 40157
Loewe 40157
Luxman 40393
LXI 40179
M
Magnavox 40157
Marantz 40029, 40157
Matsui 40157
MCS 40029
Memorex
40000, 40032, 40179, 40420,
40468
Meridian 40157
Micromega 40157
Miro 40000
Mission 40157
Modulaire
40000, 40032, 40087, 40179,
40420, 40468
MTC 40420
Musical Fidelity 40393
Myryad 40157
N
NAD 40000, 40721
Naim 40157
NSM 40157
O
Onkyo 40868, 40101
Optimus
40000, 40032, 40037, 40087,
40179, 40393, 40420, 40468
Orion 40393
P
Panasonic 40029, 40303, 40388, 40752
Parasound 40420
Penney 40029
Philips 40157
Pioneer 40032, 40101, 40468
Polk Audio 40157
Proceed 40420
Proton 40157
Q
QED 40157
Quad 40157
Quasar 40029
R
Radiola 40157
RadioShack
40000, 40032, 40179, 40420,
40468
RCA
40032, 40053, 40179, 40420,
40468
Realistic
40000, 40032, 40087, 40179,
40420, 40468
Restek 40157
Revox 40157
Roksan 40420
Rotel 40157, 40420
Royal 40420
S
SAE 40157
Saisho 40000
Sansui 40000, 40157
Sanyo 40000, 40087, 40179
SAST 40157
Sears 40179
Sharp 40037
Siemens 40157
Silsonic 40036
Simaudio 40157
Sonic Frontiers 40157
Sony
40490, 40000, 40100, 41364,
40185
Sugden 40157
Sylvania 40157
T
TAG McLaren 40157
Tandy 40032
List of preset codes / Liste de codes préréglés
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 77 2007/06/20 8:58:46
Tascam 40393, 40420
Teac 40490, 40393, 40420
Technics 40029, 40303
Techwood 40303
Thomson 40053
Thorens 40157
Thule Audio 40157
Tokai 40420
U
Universum 40157, 40053
V
Victor 40072
W
Wadia 40393
Wards
40000, 40032, 40157, 40053,
40087, 40179
Y
Yamaha 40490, 40868, 40032, 40036
Yorx 40000
CD Recorder
D
Denon 40766, 42868
J
JVC 40072
R
RCA 40053, 40420
S
Sony 40000, 40100, 41364
T
Teac 40420
Thomson 40053
Tape Deck
A
Aiwa 20029, 20197, 20200, 21315
Akai 20283, 20439
Arcam 20076
Audiolab 20029
C
Carver 20029
D
Denon
20076, 20371, 21311,
[22471]
z
F
Fisher 20074
G
Garrard 20308, 20309, 20375, 20439
Genexxa 20439
GoldStar 20375
Grundig 20029, 20375
H
Harman/Kardon 20182, 20029, 21314
I
Inkel 20070, 20071, 20337
J
JVC
20244, 20273, 20274, 20303,
20304, 20310, 21309
K
Kenwood
20070, 20071, 20092, 20233,
20234, 21364
L
LG 20375
Luxman 20308, 20309
M
Magnavox 20029
Marantz 20029, 20009
Memorex 20099
Mitsubishi 20283, 20439
Myryad 20029
O
Onkyo 20135, 20136, 20282
Optimus 20027, 20220, 20337, 20439
Orion 20308, 20309
P
Palladium 20375
Panasonic 20229
Philips 20029, 20229
Phonotrend 20337
Pioneer
20027, 20220, 20099, 20109,
21306, 21312
Polk Audio 20029
R
Radiola 20029
RCA 20027, 20220
Revox 20029
S
Sansui 20029, 20009
Sanyo 20074
Sharp 20231, 20371
Sherwood 20337
Sonic 20375
Sony
20243, 20170, 20291, 20234,
21313
T
TaeKwang 20439
Tandberg 20109
Teac
20280, 20283, 20289, 20308,
20309
Technics 20229
Technovox 20229
Thorens 20029
U
Universum 20375, 20439
V
Victor 20244, 20273, 20274
W
Wards 20027, 20029
Wharfedale 20439
Y
Yamaha 20097, 20094
HDTV Tuner
A
ABS 01272
Accurian 01653
Alienware 01272
C
CyberPower 01272
D
D-Link 01554
Dgtec 01363
E
Epson 01563
G
Gateway 01272
H
Hewlett Packard 01272, 01267
Howard Computers 01272
HP 01272, 01267
Hush 01272
I
iBUYPOWER 01272
L
LG 01415
Linksys 01272, 01365
M
Media Center PC 01272
Microsoft 01272, 01805
Mind 01272
Motorola 01363
N
Niveus Media 01272
Northgate 01272
P
Packard Bell 01272
Panasonic 01120
Pioneer 01010
R
Ricavision 01272
S
Samsung 01190, 01490
Sensory Science 01126
Sharp 01010
SMC 01456
Sony 01272, 01324, 01364
Stack 9 01272
Sylvania 01563
Systemax 01272
T
Tagar Systems 01272
Toshiba 01272
Touch 01272
V
Viewsonic 01272, 01329
Vizio 01126
Voodoo 01272
X
Xbox 01805
Z
ZT Group 01272
Satellite Receiver
A
@sat 01300
@Sky 01334
A-Mark 00345
ABsat 00123, 00713
ADB
00642, 01259, 01367, 01418,
01473, 01491
AGS 00710
Aiwa 01514
Akai 00200
Alba
00455, 00713, 01284, 01659,
01811
Allsat 00200, 01043
Alltech 00713
Allvision 01232, 01334, 01412
AlphaStar 00772
Amitronica 00713
Amstrad
00345, 00713, 00795, 00847,
00863, 00882, 01113, 01175,
01693, 01801
Anglo 00713
Ankaro 00713
AntSat 01083
Apollo 00455
Arcon 01043, 01075
Armstrong 00200
Arnion 01300
Asat 00200
ASCI 01334
ASLF 00713
AssCom 00853
Astacom 00710
Aston 00142
Astra 00713
Astratec 01743
Astro
00173, 00658, 01099, 01100,
01113
Atlantic Telephone 01333
Atsat 01300
AtSky 01334
Audioline 01672
Aurora 00642, 00879, 01333, 01433
Austar
00497, 00642, 00863, 00879,
01176, 01259
Axiel 00710
Axil 01457, 01659
Axis 01111
B
B@ytronic 01412
Beko 00455
Bell ExpressVu 00775
Big Sat 01457
Black Diamond 01284
Blaupunkt 00173
Blue Sky 00713
Boca 00713, 01232, 01366
Boston 00710, 01251
Brainwave 00658, 01672
British Sky
Broadcasting
00847, 01175, 01662, 01847
Broco 00713
BskyB 00847, 01175, 01662
BT 00710, 01296
Bubu Sat 00713
Bush
01284, 01645, 01672, 01743,
01811
C
Canal 00853
Canal Digital 00853, 01622
Canal Satellite 00853, 01339, 01853
Canal+ 00853
Centrex 01457
CGV 01413, 01567
Chaparral 00216
Cherokee 00123, 00710
Chess 00713, 01085, 01334, 01626
Chili 01718
CityCom
00299, 00394, 00818, 01075,
01176, 01232
Classic 01672
Clatronic 01413
CNS 01367
Comag 01232, 01366, 01412, 01413
Condor 01700
Conia 01695
Contec 00394
Continental Edison 01695
Coship 01457
Crossdigital 01109
Crown 01284
Cryptovision 00455, 00795
Cyfra+ 01076
Cyrus 00200
D
D-box 00723, 00873, 01114
Daewoo 00713, 01111, 01296, 01743
Delfa 00863
Deltasat 01075
Dgtec 01542, 01631, 01242
Digenius 00299
Digiality 01685
Digifusion 01645, 01743
DigiLogic 01284
DigiQuest 00863, 01300, 01457, 01473
DigiSat 01232
Digisky 01457
DigitAll World 01227
Digiturk 01076
Digiwave 01631
Dijam 01296
DiPro 01367, 01543
DirecTV
01377, 00392, 00566, 00639,
01639, 01142, 00247, 00749,
01749, 00724, 00819, 01856,
01076, 01108, 00099, 01109,
01414, 01442, 01609, 01392,
01640
Discovery 00710
Dish Network System
01505, 01005, 00775, 01775
Dishpro 01505, 01005, 00775, 01775
Distratel 01283, 01704
DMT 01075
DNT 00200
Dream Multimedia 01237
DSE 01375
DSTV 00642, 00879, 01433
Durabrand 01284
DX Antenna 01530
E
Echostar
01505, 01005, 00775, 00455,
00610, 00713, 00853, 00871,
01086, 01200, 01323, 01409,
01418, 01473, 01775
Einhell 00713
Elap 00713, 01567
Elsat 00713
Elta 00200, 01659
Emme Esse 00871
Energy Sistem 01631
Engel 00713, 01251
EP Sat 00455
Esat 00879
Eurieult 00882
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 78 2007/06/20 8:58:47
Eurocrypt 00455
EuroLine 01251
Europa 00863
Europhon 00299
Eurosky 00262, 00299
Eurostar 00818
Eutelsat 00713
Expressvu 00775, 01775
F
Fenner 00713
Ferguson 00455, 01291, 01743
Finlandia 00455
Finlux 00455
Flair Mate 00713
FMD 01251, 01413, 01457
Force 01101
Fortec Star 01083
Foxtel
00455, 00497, 00795, 00879,
01162, 01176, 01356
Fracapro Planet 00871
Fracarro 00125, 00871
France Telecom 00871
Freesat 00882
FTE 00863
FTEmaximal 00713, 00863
Fuba
00173, 00262, 00299, 00394,
01214, 01251, 01801
Fugionkyo 00125
Funai 01377
G
Galaxis
00853, 00863, 01101, 01111,
01557
Gardiner 00818
Garnet 01075
GbSAT 01214
GE 00392, 00566
Gecco 01412
General Instrument 00869
General Satellite 01176
GF Good Friends 01043
GF Star 01043
Globo
01251, 01334, 01412, 01429,
01626
GOD Digital 00200
GOI 00775, 01775
Gold Box 00853
Gold Vision 01631
Golden Interstar 01283
GoldStar 00394
Goodmans 00455, 01284, 01291
Gradiente 00887
Granada 00455
Grundig
00173, 00345, 00847, 00853,
00879, 01291
H
Handan 01622
Hanseatic 01099, 01100
Hauppauge 01672
HB 01214, 01801
HDT 01159
Hills 01232
Hirschmann
00125, 00173, 00299, 00710,
00882, 01085, 01111, 01232,
01412
Hisense 01535
Hitachi
00749, 00819, 00455, 01250,
01284, 01518, 01523, 01525
Homecast 01214, 01680, 01700
Hornet 01300
Houston 00775
HTS 00775, 01775
Hughes Network
Systems
01142, 00749, 01749, 01442
Humax
00863, 01176, 01225, 01406,
01427, 01675, 01743, 01790,
01915
Huth 01075
Hyundai 01075, 01159
I
iCan 01367
ID Digital 01176
ILLUSION sat 01557, 01631
iLo 01535
Imperial 01334, 01429, 01672
Indovision 00887
Ingelen 00882
Innova 00099
Interstar 01214
InVideo 00871
ISkyB 00887
Italtel 00871
ITT Nokia 00455, 00723, 00873
J
Jadeworld 00642
Jaeger 01334
Jerrold 00869
Jiuzhou 01450
JOK 00710
JVC 00775, 01507, 01531, 01775
K
K-SAT 00713
Kamm 00713
Kaon 01300
KaTelco 01111
Kathrein
00123, 00173, 00200, 00249,
00394, 00442, 00480, 00504,
00658, 00713, 00818, 01221,
01416, 01561, 01567
Kennex 00125
Kenwood 00853
Klap 00710
Kocmoc TB 01333
Koscom 01043
Kosmos 00442, 01333
Kreiling 00249, 00658
Kreiselmeyer 00173
Kross 01695
L
L&S Electronic 01043, 01334
Labgear 01296
LaSAT 00173, 00299
Lava 01631
Legend 01718
Legrand 01718
Lemon 01334
Lenco 00713
Lenoxx 01611
LG 01075, 01414
Lifesat 00299, 00713, 01043
Lodos 01284
Logik 01284
Logix 01075
Lorenzen 00299
Luxor 00345, 00873
M
M Electronic 00818
M vision 01557
Magnavox 00724, 00722
Manata 00710, 00713
Manhattan 00455, 00710, 01083
Marantz 00200
Maspro 00173, 00713, 01530
Master’s 00394
Matsui 00173, 00710, 01284, 01743
Maximum 01075, 01334, 01685
McIntosh 00869
MDS 01225
Mediabox 00853
Mediacom 01206
MediaSa 00853
Medion
00299, 00713, 01043, 01075,
01232, 01334, 01412, 01626
Medison 00713
Mega 00200
Memorex 00724
Metronic
00713, 00818, 01283, 01334,
01375, 01704
Metz 00173
MiCO 01811
Micro 00713
Micro Elektronic 00713
Micro Technology 00713
Micromaxx 00299
Microstar 01075
Microtec 00713
Mitsubishi 00749, 00455
Morgan’s 00200, 00713, 01232, 01412
Motorola 00869, 00856, 01473
MTEC 01214
Muller 01695
Multibroadcast 00642, 00879
Multichoice
00642, 00879, 01333, 01433,
01559, 01560
Mx Onda 01659
Myryad 00200
Mysat 00713
MySky 01693, 01848, 01850
N
NEC 01519
NEOTION 01334
Netgem 01322
Netsat 00099, 00887
Neuf TV 01322
Neuhaus 00713
Neuling 01232
Neusat 00713
Nevir 01659
Next Level 00869
Nikko 00200, 00713, 00723
Noda Electronic 01704
Nokia
00455, 00723, 00751, 00853,
00873, 01023, 01223, 01723
Nordmende 00455, 01611
O
OctalTV 01505
Okano 00442
Omega 00887
Opentel 01232, 01412
Optex
00394, 00713, 01043, 01283,
01611
Optimus 00724
Optus 00879
Orbis 01232, 01334, 01412
Orbitech 01099, 01100
Origo 00497
OSAT 00345
P
P/Sat 01232
Pace
00200, 00329, 00455, 00497,
00795, 00847, 00853, 00887,
01175, 01323, 01356, 01423,
01693, 01717, 01848, 01850
Pacific 01284, 01375
Packard Bell 01111
Packsat 00710
Palcom 00299, 01409
Panarex 01159
Panasat 00615, 00879, 01333, 01433
Panasonic
00247, 00701, 00455, 00847,
01304, 01404, 01508, 01526,
01527
Panda 00173, 00455
Pansat 01159
Patriot 00710
Paysat 00724
peeKTon 01457
Philips
01142, 00749, 01749, 00775,
00724, 00819, 01076, 00722,
00099, 00710, 00455, 00818,
00200, 00847, 00853, 00173,
01114, 00133, 01442, 01543,
01672
Phonotrend 00863, 01200
Pilotime 01339
Pino 01334
Pioneer
01142, 00329, 00853, 01308,
01442
Planet 00871
Plasmatic 00442
PMB 00713, 01611
Polytron 00394
Portland 01296
Preisner 00262, 01101, 01113, 01366
Premier 00723, 00853, 00873, 01429
Prima 00795
Primacom 01111
Primestar 00869
Profile 00710
Promax 00455
Proscan 00392, 00566
Proton 01535
Q
QNS 01367, 01402, 01404
Quadral 00710
Quelle 00299
R
Radiola 00200
RadioShack 00566, 00775, 00869
Radix 00394, 00882, 01113, 01317
RCA
00392, 00566, 01142, 00775,
00855, 00143, 01291, 01392,
01442
Rebox 01214
Regal 01251
RFT 00200
Roadstar 00713, 00853
Rollmaster 01413
Rover 00713
Rownsonic 01567
S
SAB 01251
Saba 00710, 00820
Sabre 00455
Sagem
00820, 01114, 01253, 01307,
01690
Samsung
01377, 01142, 01276, 01108,
01109, 00853, 00863, 01206,
01442, 01458, 01570, 01609,
01700, 01916
Sat Control 01300
Sat Team 00713
SAT+ 01409
Satec 00713
Satelco 01232
Satplus 01100
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 79 2007/06/20 8:58:48
Satstation 01083
Schaub Lorenz 01214
Schneider 00710, 01206, 01251
Schwaiger
00394, 00504, 00863, 01075,
01083, 01111, 01317, 01334,
01412, 01457
SCS 00299
Sedea Electronique 00125, 01206, 01283, 01626
SEG 01075, 01087, 01251, 01626
Seleco 00871
Septimo 01375
Serd 01412
Serino 00610
Servimat 01611
ServiSat 00713, 01251
Sharp 01517
Siemens 00173, 01334, 01429
Silva 00299
Skantin 00713
SKR 00713
SKY
00856, 00099, 00847, 00887,
01014, 01175, 01662, 01693,
01847, 01848, 01850
SKY Italia 00853, 01693, 01847, 01848
Sky Television 01014
Sky XL 01251, 01412
Sky+ 01175
Skymaster
00713, 01075, 01085, 01200,
01334, 01409, 01567, 01611
Skymax 00200
Skyplus 01232, 01334, 01412
SkySat 00713
Skyvision 01334
SL 00299, 01672
SM Electronic 00713, 01200, 01409
Smart
00713, 00882, 01101, 01113,
01232, 01404, 01413
Sony
00639, 01639, 00455, 00847,
00853, 01524, 01558, 01640
Star 00887
Star Choice 00869
Star Trak 00772, 00869
Starland 00713
Starlite 00200
Stream 01847, 01848
Strong
00125, 00713, 00820, 00853,
00879, 01159, 01284, 01300,
01409, 01626
Sunkai 00123
Sunny 01300
Sunsat 00713
Sunstar 00642
Supernova 00887
SVA 01455
Systec 01334
T
Tantec 00455
Tarbs 01225
Tatung 00455
TBoston 01659
Teac 01225, 01227, 01251, 01322
Tecatel 01200
TechniSat
00262, 00455, 00863, 01099,
01100, 01195, 01197, 01322
Technomate 01283, 01610
Technosonic 01672
Technotrend 01429
Techwood 01284, 01626
Tele System
Electronic
01251, 01409, 01611, 01801
Teleciel 01043
TeleClub 01367
Telefunken 00710
Teleka 00262, 00442
Telestar
01099, 01100, 01251, 01334,
01610, 01626
Telesystem 01801
Televes 00455, 01214, 01300, 01334
Televisa 00887
Telewire 01232
Tevion 00713, 01409, 01622, 01672
Thomson
00392, 00566, 00455, 00710,
00713, 00820, 00847, 00853,
01046, 01175, 01291, 01534,
01543, 01662
Thorn 00455
Tiny 01672
Tioko 00394
Tivo 01142, 01442
Tokai 00200
Tonna 00455, 00713, 01611
Topfield 01206, 01208, 01545, 01783
Toshiba
00749, 01749, 00790, 00819,
00455, 01285, 01501, 01516,
01530
TPS 00820, 01253, 01307
Triax
00200, 00713, 00853, 01113,
01227, 01251, 01291, 01296,
01626
Trio 01075
TT-micro 01429
Turnsat 00713
Twinner 00713, 01611
U
UEC 00879, 01162, 01333, 01356
UltimateTV 01392, 01640
Uniden 00724, 00722
Unisat 00200
United 01251
Universum
00173, 00299, 01087, 01099,
01251
US Digital 01535
USDTV 01535
V
Variosat 00173
Ventana 00200
Vestel 01251
VH Sat 00299
Viasat 01682
ViewSat 01232
Visionic 00125, 01283
VisionNet 01557
Visiosat
00142, 00710, 00713, 01413,
01457, 01718
Viva 00856
Vivid 01162
Voom 00869
VTech 00818
W
Wavelength 01232, 01413
Wewa 00455
Wharfedale 01284
Winbox 01801
Wintel 00299
Wisi 00173, 00299, 00455
Worldsat
00123, 00710, 01214, 01251,
01543
X
Xcom 00123
XMS 01075
Xsat
00123, 00713, 00847, 01214,
01323
Xtreme 01300
Y
Yakumo 01413
Yamada 01718
Yes 00887
Z
Zehnder
00394, 00504, 00818, 01075,
01232, 01251, 01334, 01412,
01413
Zenith 00856, 01856
Zeta Technology 00200
Zodiac 01801
DBS/PVR Combination
A
@sat 01300
Allvision 01412
Amstrad 01175
Atsat 01300
B
B@ytronic 01412
British Sky
Broadcasting
01175
BskyB 01175, 01662
Bush 01645
C
Canal Satellite 01339
Comag 01412
D
Digifusion 01645
DigiQuest 01300
Digiturk 01076
DirecTV
01377, 00392, 00639, 01142,
01076, 00099, 01392, 01442,
01640
Dish Network System
01505, 00775
Dishpro 01505, 00775
DMT 01075
Dream Multimedia 01237
E
Echostar 01505, 00775, 00610
Expressvu 00775
F
Foxtel 01356
G
GbSAT 01214
Gecco 01412
Globo 01412
H
HDT 01159
Hirschmann 01412
Homecast 01680
Hughes Network
Systems
01142, 01442
Humax 01176, 01427, 01675
Huth 01075
Hyundai 01075, 01159
K
Kaon 01300
Kathrein 00249, 00658, 01221, 01561
L
LG 01075
M
Maximum 01334
Mediacom 01206
Medion 01412
Microstar 01075
Morgan’s 01412
Motorola 00869
MTEC 01214
Multichoice 01333, 01559, 01560
MySky 01693, 01848, 01850
N
NEOTION 01334
Nokia 01023
O
Opentel 01412
Orbis 01412
P
Pace 01175, 01356, 01423, 01850
Panasonic 01304
Philips 01142, 00099, 01442
Pilotime 01339
Proscan 00392
R
Radix 01317
RCA 01392
Rebox 01214
S
Sagem 01253, 01307
Samsung 01206, 01442, 01570, 01609
Sat Control 01300
Schneider 01206
Schwaiger 01075, 01412
Sedea Electronique 01206
Serd 01412
SKY 01175, 01693, 01848, 01850
SKY Italia 01848
Sky XL 01412
Skymaster 01075
Skyplus 01412
Sony 00639, 01640
Star Choice 00869
Strong 01300
Sunny 01300
T
TechniSat 01195, 01197
Thomson 01175, 01534, 01662
Topfield 01206, 01545, 01783
TPS 01253, 01307
X
Xtreme 01300
Z
Zehnder 01075, 01412
Television
1
888 10264
A
A-Mark 10047, 10054, 10009
A.R. Systems
10037, 10352, 10374, 10455,
10556
Accent 10009, 10037
Accuscan 10047
Accuscreen 10001
Acoustic Research 11269
Action 10030, 10650
Acura 10009
Addison 10092, 10108, 10653
ADL 11217
Admiral
10047, 10054, 10017, 10051,
10093, 10463, 10180, 10163,
10264, 10418
Advent
10761, 10783, 10815, 10817,
10842, 10876, 11933
Adventuri 10000
Adyson 10217
AEG 11163, 11556
Agashi 10217, 10264
Agna 10150
Aiko
10092, 10009, 10035, 10037,
10217, 10264, 10361, 10371,
10433
Aim 10706, 10037, 10455, 10805
Aiwa 10264, 10701, 11904, 11911
Akai
10000, 10060, 10812, 10702,
10178, 10030, 10145, 10602,
10606, 10631, 10648, 10672,
10714, 10715, 11207, 11537,
11675, 11676, 11903, 10556,
10548, 10480, 10433, 10371,
10361, 10264, 10218, 10217,
10208, 10163, 10037, 10035,
10009
Akashi 10009, 10860
Akiba 10037, 10218, 10455
Akira 10418
Akito 10037
Akura
10171, 10009, 10037, 10163,
10218, 10264, 10668, 10714,
11037, 11498, 11556, 11982
Alaron 10170
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 80 2007/06/20 8:58:50
Alba
10009, 10036, 10037, 10073,
10163, 10218, 10352, 10370,
10371, 10418, 10443, 10487,
10668, 10714, 11037
Albatron 10700, 10843
Alfide 10672
All-Tel 10865, 11269
Alleron 10030, 10170
Allorgan 10217
Allstar 10037
Ambassador 10150
America Action 10180
American High 10000, 10060
Amplivision 10217, 10370
Amstrad
10000, 10171, 10009, 10011,
10037, 10163, 10218, 10264,
10362, 10371, 10433, 10648,
11037, 11982
Amtron 10000, 10180
Anam
10250, 10180, 10009, 10037,
10700, 10861
Anam National 10250, 10037, 10650
Andersson 11149, 11163
Anglo 10009, 10264
Anhua 10051
Anitech 10009, 10037, 10264
Ansonic
10009, 10037, 10163, 10370,
10374, 10668
AOC
10451, 10093, 10180, 10060,
10178, 10030, 10092, 10009,
10108
Aolinpike 10264
Apex Digital
10156, 10748, 10879, 10765,
10767, 11217, 11943
AR 10352, 10556
Arc En Ciel 10109
Arcam 10217
Ardem 10037, 10714
Aristocrat 10163
Aristona 10037, 10556
ART 11037
Arthur Martin 10163
ASA 10070
Asberg 10037
Asora 10009
Astra 10037
Asuka 10217, 10218, 10264
ATD 10698
Atlantic 10001, 10037
Atori 10009
Auchan 10163
Audinac 10180
Audiosonic
10009, 10037, 10109, 10217,
10218, 10264, 10370, 10374,
10486, 10714, 10715, 10820
Audioton 10217, 10264, 10370, 10486
Audiovox
10451, 10180, 10092, 10623,
10802, 10875, 11937, 11951,
11952
Audioworld 10698
Aumark 10060
Autovox 10217
Aventura 10171
AVP 10000
Awa
10451, 10009, 10011, 10036,
10108, 10217, 10264, 10374,
10606
Axion 11937, 11958
Axxent 10009
B
Baier 10876
Baihe 10009, 10264
Baile 10001, 10009, 10374, 10661
Baird
10037, 10073, 10109, 10208,
10217, 10343, 11196
Bang & Olufsen 10565
Baohuashi 10264
Baosheng 10009, 10817
Barco 10163, 10556
Basic Line
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217,
10218, 10374, 10455, 10556,
10668, 11037, 11163
Bastide 10217
Bauer 10805
Baur
10037, 10195, 10361, 10455,
10512
Baysonic 10180
Bazin 10217
Beaumark 10017, 10178, 10030
Beijing
10812, 10001, 10009, 10208,
10226, 10264, 10374, 10661,
10817, 10821
Beko
10037, 10195, 10370, 10418,
10486, 10606, 10714, 10715,
10808, 11037
Belcor 10030
Bell & Howell 10054, 10017, 10154, 10093
Belson 10698, 11191
Belstar 11037
BenQ 11032, 11756
Beon 10037, 10163, 10218, 10418
Berthen 10668
Best 10370
Bestar 10037, 10370, 10374
Bestar-Daewoo 10374
Binatone 10217
Black Diamond
10614, 10820, 10821, 11037,
11163, 11909
Blackway 10218
Blaupunkt
10036, 10170, 10195, 10200,
10327, 10455
Blue Sky
10037, 10218, 10455, 10487,
10499, 10556, 10668, 10714,
10715, 11037, 11191, 11363
Boots 10009, 10217
BPL 10037, 10208
Bradford 10180
Brandt
10109, 10287, 10335, 10560,
10625, 10714
Brinkmann 10037, 10418, 10486, 10668
Brionvega 10037, 10362
Britannia 10217
Brockwood 10178, 10030
Broksonic
10236, 10463, 10180, 11911,
11938
Brother 10264
BSR 10163
BTC 10218
Bush
11900, 11556, 11037, 10778,
10714, 10698, 10668, 10661,
10614, 10556, 10487, 10374,
10371, 10361, 10335, 10264,
10218, 10217, 10208, 10163,
10037, 10036, 10009
C
Caihong 10009, 10817
Cailing 10748
Candle 10030
Canton 10218
Capehart
10017, 10178, 10030, 10092,
10036
Capetronic 10030
Capsonic 10264
Carad 10610, 10668, 11037
Carena 10037, 10455
Carnivale 10030
Carrefour 10036, 10037, 10070
Carver 10054, 10170
Cascade 10009, 10037
Casio 10037
Cathay 10037, 10218
CCE 10037, 10217
Celebrity 10000
Celera 10765
Celestial 10767, 10819, 10820, 10821
Centrex 10780
Centrum 11037
Centurion 10037
CGE 10074, 10163, 10370, 10418
Changcheng
10051, 10001, 10009, 10264,
10374, 10661, 10817
Changfei 10009, 10374, 10817
Changfeng 10264, 10817
Changhai 10009, 10817
Changhong
10156, 10765, 10009, 10264,
10508, 10767, 10783, 10817,
10819, 10820, 10821, 11008,
11156
Chengdu 10009, 10817
Ching Tai 10092, 10009
Chun Yun
10000, 10180, 10092, 10009,
10700, 10843
Chunfeng 10009, 10264
Chung Hsin 10180, 10053, 10036, 10108
Chunsun 10009, 10817
Cimline 10009, 10218
Cinema 10672
Cineral 10451, 10092
Cinex 10648, 11556
Citek 10047
Citizen
10054, 10000, 10451, 10463,
10180, 10060, 10030, 10171,
10092, 10001, 10035
City 10009
Clarion 10180
Clarivox 10037, 10070, 10418
Classic 10030, 10092, 10499
Clatronic
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10370, 10371, 10714
Clayton 11037
CMS Hightec 10217
Colortyme
10047, 10054, 10017, 10060,
10178, 10030
Commercial Solutions
11447, 10047
Concorde 10009
Condor
10009, 10037, 10264, 10370,
10418
Conia 10820, 10821, 11498
Conic 10178
Conrac 10808
Conrowa
10156, 10145, 10009, 10264,
10698, 11156, 11170
Contec 10180, 10009, 10036, 10037
Continental Edison 10109, 10287, 10487
Cosmel 10009, 10037
Craig 10180, 10171
Crosley
10054, 10000, 10180, 10030,
10171, 10074, 10163, 10370
Crown
10093, 10180, 10053, 10009,
10037, 10208, 10370, 10418,
10486, 10487, 10606, 10672,
10712, 10714, 10715, 11037
Crown Mustang 10672
CS Electronics 10218
CTX 11756
Curtis Mathes
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10051, 10451, 10093, 10180,
10060, 10702, 10178, 10030,
10145, 10166, 10037, 10035,
11147, 11347
CXC 10180
Cybertron 10218
Cytronix 11298
D
D-Vision 10037, 10556, 11982
Daewoo
10154, 10451, 10180, 10178,
10030, 10092, 11661, 10634,
10661, 10672, 10700, 10860,
10865, 10876, 10880, 11755,
11756, 11909, 10623, 10556,
10499, 10374, 10264, 10218,
10217, 10170, 10109, 10108,
10037, 10036, 10009
Dainichi 10218
Dansai
10009, 10035, 10036, 10037,
10208, 10217
Dantax 10370, 10486, 10714, 10715
Datsura 10208
Dawa 10009, 10037
Daytek 10672, 11207
Dayton 10092, 10009, 11207
Daytron
10180, 10178, 10030, 10092,
10009, 10036, 10037, 10374
Dayu 10374, 10661
De Graaf 10163, 10208, 10548
Decca 10037, 10217
Degraff 10163, 10208
Deitron 10374
Dell 11080, 11178
Denko 10264
Denon 10145, 10511
Denver 10037, 10587
Desmet 10009, 10037
Diamant 10037
Diamond
10706, 10009, 10371, 10672,
10698, 10820, 10860
Digatron 10037
Digiline 10037, 10668
Digital Life 10872
Digitex 10820
Digitor 10037
Digix Media 10880
Dixi 10009, 10037, 10217
DL 10587, 10780, 10872
Domeos 10668
Domland 10394
Dongda 10009
Donghai 10009
Dream Vision 11164, 11704
DSE 10698, 10820, 11556
DTS 10009
Dual
10037, 10217, 10343, 10352,
10394, 11037, 11137
Dual Tec 10217
Dumont
10017, 10180, 10178, 10070,
10217
Durabrand
10463, 10180, 10178, 10171,
11034, 11463
Dux 10037
Dwin 10093
Dynatech 10217
Dynatron 10037
E
Easy Living 11248
Eaton 10060
Ecco 10773
ECE 10037
Edison-Minerva 10487
Elbe
10037, 10217, 10218, 10362,
10610
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 81 2007/06/20 8:58:51
Elcit 10163
Electroband 10000
Electrograph 11755
Electrohome
10154, 10000, 10463, 10150,
10178, 10030, 10073
Elekta 10009, 10264
Elfunk 11037, 11208
ELG 10037
Elin 10009, 10037, 10361, 10548
Elite 10037, 10218
Elta 10009, 10264
Emerald 10178
Emerson
10047, 10017, 10154, 10451,
10236, 10463, 10180, 10150,
10178, 10171, 11944, 11911,
11909, 10714, 10668, 10623,
10486, 10036, 10371, 10370,
10361, 10037, 10195, 10170,
10070, 10073
Envision 10030, 10813
Enzer 10860
Erae 11371
Erres 10037
ESA 10812, 10171, 11944
ESC 10037, 10217
Ether 10030, 10009
Etron 10001, 10009, 10163, 10820
Eurofeel 10217, 10264
Euroman 10037, 10217, 10264, 10370
Europa 10037
Europhon 10037, 10109, 10217
Evesham Technology 11248
Evolution 11756
Expert 10163
Exquisit 10037
F
Feilang 10009
Feilu 10009, 10817
Feiyan 10264
Feiyue 10009, 10817
Fenner 10009, 10374
Fer0 10335
Ferguson
10053, 10037, 10073, 10109,
10195, 10287, 10335, 10343,
10443, 10548, 10560, 10625,
11037
Fidelity
10171, 10037, 10163, 10217,
10264, 10361, 10371, 10512
Filsai 10217
Finlandia
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361,
10548
Finlux
10037, 10070, 10163, 10217,
10346, 10480, 10556, 10631,
10714, 10715, 10808, 11556
Firstar 10236, 10009
Firstline
10009, 10037, 10208, 10217,
10361, 10374, 10556, 10668,
10714, 10808, 11037, 11191,
11363, 11371
Fisher
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10036, 10208, 10217, 10361,
10370
Flint
10037, 10218, 10264, 10455,
10610
Force 11149
Formenti 10037, 10163
Fortress 10093
Fraba 10037, 10370
Friac
10009, 10037, 10370, 10499,
10610
Frontech 10009, 10163, 10217, 10264
Fujimaro 10865, 11498
Fujitsu
10009, 10217, 10352, 10683,
10809, 10853
Fujitsu General 10009, 10217, 10683
Fujitsu Siemens 10808, 10809, 11163, 11298
Funai
10000, 10180, 10171, 10264,
10668, 11271, 11904
Furi 10145, 10264, 10817
Furichi 10860
Futronic 10264, 10860
Futuretech 10180
G
Galaxi 10037
Galaxis 10037, 10370
Ganxin 10817
Gateway 11755, 11756
GBC 10009, 10163, 10218, 10374
GE
11447, 10047, 11454, 10000,
10051, 10451, 10093, 10180,
10060, 10178, 10030, 10092,
11922, 11917, 11347, 11147,
10625, 10560, 10335, 10035
GEC 10037, 10163, 10217, 10361
Geloso 10009, 10163, 10374
Gemini 10047
General 10109, 10287
General Technic 10009
Genesis 10009, 10037
Genexxa 10009, 10037, 10163, 10218
Gericom
10808, 10865, 10880, 11217,
11298
Gevalt 11371
Giant 10009, 10217
Gibralter 10017, 10000, 10030
Go Video 10060, 10886
Go Vision 11937
Goldfunk 10668
GoldStar
10047, 10054, 10154, 10178,
10030, 10715, 10714, 10606,
10455, 10361, 10217, 10163,
10109, 10073, 10037, 10036,
10009, 10001
Gooding 10487
Goodmans
10000, 11909, 11900, 11163,
11037, 10880, 10808, 10714,
10668, 10661, 10634, 10625,
10587, 10560, 10556, 10499,
10487, 10480, 10374, 10371,
10343, 10335, 10264, 10218,
10217, 10037, 10036, 10035,
10011, 10009
Gorenje 10370
GPM 10218
Gradiente 10053, 10037, 10170
Graetz
10163, 10361, 10371, 10487,
10714, 11163
Gran Prix 10648
Granada
10036, 10037, 10108, 10163,
10208, 10217, 10226, 10343,
10548, 10560
Grandin
10009, 10037, 10163, 10218,
10374, 10455, 10610, 10668,
10714, 10715, 10865, 10880,
11037, 11191
Gronic 10217
Grundig
10706, 10009, 10036, 10037,
10070, 10163, 10195, 10443,
10487, 10556, 10587, 10672,
10683, 11371
Grundy 10180, 10195
Grunkel 11163
Grunpy 10180
H
H & B 10808
Haaz 10706
Haier
11034, 10037, 10508, 10587,
10698, 11017
Haihong 10009
Haiyan 10264, 10817
Halifax 10217, 10264
Hallmark 10236, 10180, 10178
Hampton 10217
Hanimex 10218
Hankook 10180, 10178, 10030
Hanseatic
10009, 10037, 10217, 10361,
10370, 10394, 10499, 10556,
10634, 10661, 10714, 10808
Hantarex 10009, 10037, 10865
Hantor 10037
Harley Davidson
10000, 10180, 10060, 10178,
10030, 11904
Harman/Kardon 10054
Harsper 10865
Harvard 10180
Harwa 10773, 11196, 11269
Harwood 10009, 10037, 10487
Hauppauge 10037
Havermy 10093
HCM
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10418
Heathkit 10017
Helios 10865
Hello Kitty 10451
Hema 10009, 10217
Hewlett Packard 11494, 11502
Hifivox 10109
Highline 10037, 10264
Hikona 10218
Hikone 10218
Hinari
10009, 10036, 10037, 10163,
10208, 10218, 10264, 10352,
10443
Hisawa 10218, 10455, 10610, 10714
Hisense
10156, 10748, 10145, 10009,
10208, 10508, 10556, 10780,
10821, 10860, 11022, 11156,
11170, 11208, 11363
Hitachi
10047, 10054, 10017, 10000,
11256, 10156, 10051, 10150,
10178, 10030, 11145, 10145,
10092, 10744, 10877, 10634,
11037, 11137, 11149, 11156,
11170, 11225, 11576, 11904,
11960, 10578, 10548, 10508,
10499, 10481, 10480, 10343,
10217, 10163, 10109, 10108,
10037, 10036, 10035, 10009
Hitachi Fujian 10150, 10108, 10860
Hitec 10698
Hitsu 10009, 10218, 10455, 10610
Hoeher 10714, 10865, 11163, 11556
Home Electronics 10606
Hongmei 10093, 10009, 10264, 10817
Hongyan 10264, 10817
Hornyphon 10037
Hoshai 10218, 10455
HP 11494, 11502
Hua Tun 10009
Huafa 10145, 10009
Huanghaimei 10009
Huanghe 10009, 10817
Huanglong 10009
Huangshan 10009, 10264, 10817
Huanyu 10217, 10264, 10374, 10817
Huaqiang 10264
Huari 10145, 10264
Hugoson 11217
Huodateji 10051
Hygashi 10217
Hyper 10009, 10217
Hypersonic 10361
Hypson
10037, 10217, 10264, 10455,
10486, 10556, 10668, 10714,
10715, 11037
Hyundai
10849, 10860, 10865, 10876,
11556
I
Iberia 10037
ICE
10037, 10217, 10218, 10264,
10371
ICeS 10218
Iiyama 10877, 11217
Ima 10236, 10180, 10178
Imperial 10037, 10074, 10370, 10418
Imperial Crown
10001, 10009, 10264, 10374,
10661
Indiana 10037
Infinity 10054
InFocus 11164
Ingelen 10163, 10487, 10610, 10714
Ingersol 10009
Inno Hit 10009, 10217, 10218, 11163
Innova 10037
Innowert 10865, 11298
Inotech 10773, 10820
Insignia 10171, 11517
Inteq 10017, 10145
Interbuy 10009, 10037, 10264
Interfunk
10037, 10109, 10163, 10200,
10327, 10361, 10512
Internal 10037, 11909
Intervision
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10394, 10455, 10486,
10487
Irradio 10009, 10037, 10218, 10371
Isukai 10037, 10218, 10455
ITC 10217
ITS 10037, 10218, 10264, 10371
ITT
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361,
10480, 10548, 10610
ITT Nokia
10070, 10163, 10195, 10208,
10346, 10361, 10480, 10548,
10606, 10610
ITV 10037, 10264, 10374
IX 10877
J
JBL 10054
JCB 10000
JDV 11982
Jean
10156, 10051, 10236, 10092,
10009, 10036
JEC 10035
Jensen 10761, 10815, 10817, 11933
Jiahua 10051
JiaLiCai 10009, 10264
JIL 10030
Jinfeng 10051, 10208, 10226, 10817
Jinque 10009, 10264, 10817
Jinta 10009, 10264
Jinxing
10054, 10156, 10145, 10009,
10037, 10264, 10556, 10698,
10817, 10821, 11011
JMB 10443, 10499, 10556, 10634
JNC 10876
Jocel 10712
Johnson 10455
Jubilee 10556
Juhua 10264, 10817
Jutan 10030
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 82 2007/06/20 8:58:52
JVC
10054, 10093, 10463, 10053,
10030, 10070, 10036, 10218,
10371, 10418, 10508, 10606,
10650, 10653, 10683, 10731,
11253, 11923
K
Kaige 10009, 10264, 10817
Kaisui
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10455
Kambrook 10217
Kamp 10017, 10180, 10217
Kangli
10001, 10009, 10264, 10374,
10661, 10817
Kangyi 10009, 10264
Kapsch 10163, 10361
Karcher
10264, 10370, 10606, 10610,
10714, 10778, 11556
Kathrein 10556
Kawa 10371
Kawasho 10030
KB Aristocrat 10163
KDS 11498
KEC 10180, 10060
Kendo
10037, 10362, 10370, 10610,
10648, 11037
Kennedy 10163
Kennex 10668, 11037
Kenwood 10180, 10030
Khind 10706
KIC 10217
Kiota 10001, 10371, 10455
Kioto 10706, 10556
Kiton 10037, 10668
KLH
10156, 10180, 10765, 10767,
11962
KLL 10037
Kloss 10030
Kneissel
10037, 10362, 10370, 10374,
10499, 10556, 10610
Kolin
10180, 10150, 10053, 10036,
10108, 11331
Kolster 10037, 10218
Kongque 10009, 10264, 10817
Konichi 10009
Konig 10037
Konka
10180, 10037, 10218, 10371,
10418, 10587, 10641, 10714,
10817, 11084
Kontakt 10487
Korpel 10037
Korting 10370
Kosmos 10037
Koyoda 10009
Kreisen 10876
KTV 10463, 10180, 10030, 10217
Kuaile 10009, 10264
Kulun 10009
Kunlun
10051, 10208, 10226, 10264,
10374, 10661, 10817
Kyoshu 10418
Kyoto 10163, 10217
L
L&S Electronic 10714, 10808, 10865
Lark 10154
LaSAT 10486
Lavis 11037
Leader 10009
Lecson 10037
Legend 10009
Lenco 10037, 10374, 10587
Lenoir 10009
Lexsor 11196
Leyco 10037, 10264
LG
10054, 11265, 10060, 10178,
10030, 11758, 11637, 11191,
11178, 10856, 10715, 10714,
10700, 10698, 10556, 10370,
10361, 10217, 10163, 10109,
10108, 10037, 10009, 10001
Liesenk & Tter 10037
Liesenkotter 10037, 10327
Lifetec
10009, 10037, 10218, 10374,
10668, 10683, 10714, 11037,
11137
Lihua 10817
Lloyd’s
10236, 10180, 10030, 10001,
10009, 11904
Local India TV 10009, 10208, 10602
Local Malaysia TV 10698
Lodos 11037
Loewe
10037, 10370, 10512, 10633,
10790
Logik
10236, 10180, 10060, 10001,
10009, 10011, 10371, 10698,
10773, 10880, 11037, 11217
Logix 10668
Longjiang 10264, 10817
Luker 11982
Luma
10009, 10163, 10362, 10374,
11037
Lumatron
10037, 10073, 10163, 10217,
10264, 10361, 10556
Lux May 10009, 10037
Luxor
10163, 10208, 10217, 10346,
10361, 10480, 10548, 10631,
11037, 11163
LXI
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10000, 10156, 10051, 10093,
10060, 10053, 10178, 10030,
10171, 10166, 10037, 10036,
10035, 10001, 10208
M
M Electronic
10009, 10037, 10109, 10163,
10195, 10217, 10287, 10343,
10346, 10374, 10480, 10512,
10634, 10661, 10714
Madison 10037
MAG 11498
Magnadyne 10054, 10163
Magnafon 10073
Magnasonic
10054, 10000, 10156, 10093,
10030, 10092, 10109
Magnavox
10047, 11454, 10054, 10154,
10000, 10250, 10051, 10180,
10060, 10030, 10171, 10092,
10706, 11944, 11904, 11755,
11254, 10802, 10780, 10011,
10035, 10037, 10036
Magnum 10037, 10648, 10714, 10715
Majestic 10017
Mandor 10264
Manesth 10035, 10037, 10217, 10264
Manhattan
10037, 10668, 10778, 10876,
11037, 11267
Marantz
11454, 10054, 10030, 10037,
10556, 10704, 10855
Mark
10009, 10037, 10217, 10374,
10714, 10715
Master’s 10499
Mastro 10053, 10706, 10698, 10780
Masuda
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10371
Matsui
11037, 10744, 10714, 10556,
10487, 10455, 10443, 10433,
10371, 10352, 10335, 10217,
10208, 10195, 10163, 10037,
10036, 10035, 10011, 10009
Matsushita 10250, 10051, 10650
Maxdorf 10773
Maxent 11755, 11756
Maxim 11556, 11982
MCE 10009
Meck 10698
Mediator 10037, 10556
Medion
10037, 10512, 10556, 10668,
10698, 10714, 10808, 10880,
11037, 11137, 11248, 11900
Megapower 10700
Megas 10610
Megatron 10047, 10178, 10145, 10009
MEI 11037
Meile 10264, 10817
Memorex
10154, 10250, 10463, 10180,
10150, 10060, 10178, 10030,
10009, 10035, 10037, 10195,
10877, 11037, 11911
Memphis 10009
Mercury 10060, 10001, 10009, 10037
Mermaid 10037
Metronic 10625
Metz
10037, 10195, 10367, 10388,
10447, 10587, 10668, 10746,
11163
MGA
10150, 10178, 10030, 10218,
10374
MGN Technology 10178
Micro Genius 10150
Micromaxx
10037, 10668, 10714, 10808,
11037
Microstar 10808
MicroTEK 10820, 10860
Midland 10047, 10017, 10051
Mikomi 11037, 11149
Minato 10037, 10556
Minerva 10070, 10108, 10195, 10487
Minoka 10037
Mirror 11900
Mitsubishi
10154, 10250, 10093, 10236,
10180, 11250, 10150, 10178,
10030, 11917, 11037, 10836,
10817, 10556, 10512, 10195,
10108, 10037, 10036, 10011
Mivar 10217
Monaco 10009
Monivision 10700, 10843
Morgan’s 10037
Motorola 10054, 10051, 10093, 10150
MTC
10180, 10060, 10030, 10092,
10011, 10370, 10512
MTlogic 10714
Mudan
10051, 10009, 10208, 10226,
10264, 10817
Multitec
10037, 10486, 10668, 11037,
11556
Multitech
10180, 10009, 10037, 10217,
10264, 10370, 10486
Murphy 10163
Musikland 10218
Mx Onda 11498
Myryad 10556
N
NAD
10156, 10178, 10166, 10037,
10361, 10866, 11156
Naiko 10037, 10606, 11982
Nakimura 10037, 10374
Nanbao 10009, 10264
Nansheng 10264, 10817
Narita 11982
NAT 10226
National 10051, 10208, 10226, 10508
NEC
10047, 10154, 10156, 10051,
10053, 10178, 10030, 11704,
11270, 11170, 10817, 10704,
10661, 10653, 10508, 10499,
10455, 10374, 10264, 10217,
10170, 10036, 10011, 10009
Neckermann
10037, 10200, 10327, 10370,
10418, 10556
NEI 10037, 10163, 10371
Neovia 10865, 10876, 11371
Netsat 10037
NetTV 11755
Neufunk
10009, 10037, 10218, 10556,
10610, 10714
New Tech
10009, 10037, 10217, 10343,
10556
New World 10218
Newave 10093, 10178, 10092, 10009
Nikkai
10009, 10035, 10036, 10037,
10163, 10217, 10218, 10264
Nikkei 10714
Nikko 10178, 10030, 10092
Nikkodo 10178, 10030, 10092
Nishi 10030
Nobliko 10070
Nogamatic 10109
Nokia
10163, 10208, 10346, 10361,
10374, 10480, 10548, 10606,
10610, 10631
Norcent 10748, 10824
Nordic 10217
Nordmende
10037, 10109, 10195, 10287,
10343, 10560, 10714
Normerel 10037
Novatronic 10037, 10374
NTC 10092
Nu-Tec 10455, 10698, 10820
Nyon 10000
O
Oceanic 10163, 10208, 10361, 10548
Odeon 10264
Okano 10009, 10037, 10264, 10370
Olevia 11144, 11240, 11331, 11610
Omega 10264
Omni 10748, 10698, 10780, 10872
Onida 10053, 11253
Onimax 10714
Onwa
10180, 10218, 10371, 10433,
10602
Opera 10037
Optimus
10154, 10250, 10093, 10180,
10150, 10178, 10030, 10166,
10650
Optoma 10887
Optonica 10093
Orbit 10037
Orcom 11504
Orion
10017, 10236, 10463, 10180,
10178, 11463, 10011, 10037,
10264, 10443, 10556, 10714,
10880, 11196, 11911
Orline 10037, 10218
Ormond 10668, 11037
Osaki
10037, 10217, 10218, 10264,
10374, 10556
Osio 10037
Oso 10218
Osume 10036, 10037, 10218
Otic 11498
Otto Versand
10093, 10036, 10037, 10109,
10195, 10217, 10226, 10343,
10361, 10512, 10556
P
Pace 10092
Pacific
10037, 10443, 10556, 10714,
11037, 11137
Palladium
10037, 10163, 10200, 10217,
10327, 10370, 10418, 10556,
10714, 11137
Palsonic
10001, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10418, 10698, 10773,
10778, 11196, 11269, 11904
Panama 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264
Panashiba 10001
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 83 2007/06/20 8:58:54
Panasonic
10054, 10000, 10156, 10250,
10051, 10236, 10030, 11947,
11946, 11941, 11480, 11310,
11291, 11271, 10853, 10650,
10548, 10508, 10367, 10361,
10226, 10208, 10163, 10108,
10037, 10035
Panavision 10037
Panda
10051, 10706, 10009, 10208,
10226, 10264, 10508, 10698,
10780, 10817, 10821
Pathe Cinema 10163
Pathe Marconi 10109
Pausa 10009
Paxonic 10060, 10030
PCE 10156, 10060
Penney
10047, 10000, 10156, 10250,
10051, 10060, 10178, 10030,
10035, 10036, 10037, 10070,
10108, 11347
Perdio 10037, 10163
Perfekt 10037
Petters 11523
Philco
10054, 10451, 10463, 10180,
10178, 10030, 10145, 11661,
10037, 10074, 10163, 10370,
10418
Philharmonic 10217
Philips
11454, 10054, 10017, 10000,
10051, 10178, 10030, 10171,
10092, 11961, 11756, 11254,
10690, 10556, 10512, 10374,
10361, 10343, 10200, 10108,
10037, 10009
Phocus 10714
Phoenix 10037, 10163, 10370, 10486
Phonola 10037, 10556
Pilot
10051, 10060, 10178, 10030,
10706, 10011
Pioneer
10166, 10011, 10037, 10109,
10163, 10170, 10287, 10361,
10370, 10486, 10512, 10679,
10760, 10866, 11260
Pionier 10370, 10486, 11556
Plantron 10009, 10037, 10264
Playsonic 10037, 10217, 10714, 10715
Polaroid
10765, 10865, 11276, 11316,
11341, 11498, 11523
Poppy 10009
Portland 10451, 10092, 10374
Powerpoint 10037, 10487, 10698
Prandoni-Prince 10361
Precision 10236, 10180, 10217
Premier 10009, 10264
President 10860
Prima
10761, 10009, 10264, 10783,
10815, 10817, 11269, 11933
Princeton 10700
Prinston 11037
Prinz 10361
Prism 10250, 10051
Profex 10009, 10163, 10361
Profi 10009
Profilo 11556
Profitronic 10037
Proline
10037, 10073, 10625, 10634,
11037
Proscan 11447, 10047, 11347, 11922
Prosco 10156
Prosonic
10037, 10217, 10370, 10371,
10374, 10668, 10714
Protec 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264
Protech
10009, 10037, 10217, 10264,
10418, 10486, 10668, 11037
Proton 10178, 10030, 10001, 10009
Proview 11498
ProVision 10037, 10556, 10714, 11037
Pulsar 10017, 10092
Pulser 10178, 10092
Pvision 10876, 11191
Pye 10037, 10374, 10556
Pymi 10009
Q
Qingdao
10051, 10208, 10226, 10264,
10817
Quadral 10051, 10218
Quartz 10150, 10178
Quasar
10250, 10051, 10009, 10035,
10650, 10865
Quelle
10011, 10037, 10070, 10074,
10109, 10195, 10200, 10327,
10361, 10512, 10668, 11037
Questa 10036
Questar 10036
R
R-Line 10037
Rabbit 10047
Radialva 10163, 10218
Radiola 10037, 10217, 10556
Radiomarelli 10037
RadioShack
10047, 10154, 10180, 10150,
10178, 10030, 10037, 11904
Radiotone
10009, 10037, 10264, 10370,
10418, 10648, 10668, 11037
Rank 10070
Rank Arena 10036, 10602
RBM 10070
RCA
11447, 10047, 11454, 10054,
10000, 10051, 10093, 10178,
10030, 10092, 11958, 11953,
11948, 11922, 11917, 11547,
11347, 11247, 11147, 11047,
10679, 10625, 10560, 10090
Realistic
10047, 10154, 10180, 10150,
10178, 10030
Recor 10037, 10418
Rectiligne 10037
Rediffusion
10036, 10163, 10346, 10361,
10548
Redstar 10037
Reflex 10037, 10668, 11037
Relisys
10865, 10876, 10877, 11207,
11298
Remotec
10250, 10093, 10145, 10171,
10037
Reoc 10714
Revox 10037
Rex 10163, 10264
RFT 10037, 10264
Rinex 10773
Roadstar
10009, 10037, 10218, 10264,
10418, 10668, 10714, 11037,
11900
Rolson 11371
Rover 10036, 10877
Rowa
10748, 10009, 10037, 10264,
10587, 10698, 10712, 10817
Royal Lux 10335, 10370
Runco 10017, 10060, 10030
Ruyi 10817
S
Saba
10250, 10109, 10163, 10287,
10335, 10343, 10361, 10498,
10548, 10560, 10625, 10714
Sagem 10455, 10610, 10618
Saige 10009, 10817
Saisho
10009, 10011, 10163, 10217,
10264
Saivod
10037, 10668, 10712, 11037,
11163, 11556, 11982
Sakai 10163
Sakyno 10455
Salora
10163, 10208, 10361, 10480,
10548, 10631
Salsa 10335
Sampo
10047, 10154, 10093, 10178,
10030, 10171, 10092, 10009,
10036, 10650, 10700, 11755,
11756
Samsung
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10156, 10093, 10060, 10812,
10702, 10178, 10030, 10092,
10814, 10766, 10718, 10618,
10587, 10817, 10821, 11060,
11249, 11312, 11903, 11959,
10556, 10371, 10370, 10362,
10264, 10226, 10217, 10208,
10163, 10090, 10037, 10036,
10035, 10009
Sandra 10217
Sanjian 10264
Sanky 10060, 10030
Sansui
10463, 10060, 10030, 10706,
10037, 10371, 10455, 10602,
10714, 10861, 11371, 11537,
11904, 11911
Santon 10009
Sanyo
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10156, 10463, 10180, 10145,
10171, 11755, 11208, 10704,
10508, 10370, 10264, 10217,
10208, 10170, 10163, 10108,
10088, 10037, 10036, 10011,
10009
Sanyong 10037
Sanyuan 10093, 10009, 10817
Saville 10060
SBR 10037, 10556
Sceptre 11217
Schaub Lorenz
10361, 10374, 10486, 10548,
10606, 10714, 11191
Schneider
11982, 11904, 11137, 11037,
10714, 10668, 10648, 10556,
10394, 10371, 10361, 10352,
10343, 10218, 10217, 10163,
10070, 10037
Scotch 10178
Scotland 10163
Scott 10236, 10180, 10178, 10030
Sears
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10000, 10156, 10051, 10093,
10060, 10053, 10178, 10030,
10171, 10166, 10035, 10036,
10037, 10001, 10208, 11904
Seaway 10634
Seelver 11037
SEG
10009, 10036, 10037, 10217,
10218, 10264, 10362, 10487,
10668, 11037, 11163
SEI 10037, 10163
Sei-Sinudyne 10037
Seleco
10163, 10264, 10346, 10362,
10371
Semivox 10180
Semp 10156
Sencora 10009
Sentra 10035
Serino 10093, 10455, 10610
Shancha 10264, 10817
Shanghai
10009, 10208, 10226, 10264,
10817
Shaofeng 10145, 10817
Sharp
10054, 10093, 10180, 10053,
10030, 10009, 10036, 10200,
10650, 10653, 10668, 11193,
11393, 11917
Shen Ying 10092, 10009
Shencai 10145, 10009, 10264
Sheng Chia 10093, 10236, 10009
Shenyang 10009, 10264, 10817
Sherwood 10009
Shintoshi 10037
Shivaki
10178, 10037, 10374, 10443,
10556
Show 10009, 10418
Siarem 10163
Siemens
10145, 10037, 10195, 10200,
10327
Siera 10037, 10556
Siesta 10370
Signature 10047, 10093, 10030
Silva 10037, 10361, 10648
Silva Schneider 10037, 11556
Silvano 10587
Silver 10036, 10361, 10455, 10715
SilverCrest 11037
Simpson 10178, 10030, 10011
Singer
10060, 10092, 10009, 10037,
10335, 10371, 10433, 11537
Sinotec 10773
Sinudyne 10037, 10163, 10361
Skantic 10163
SKY 10037, 10880, 11504
Sky Brazil 10880
Sky-North 10037
Skygiant 10180
Skyworth
10748, 10009, 10037, 10264,
10698, 10805, 10817, 11115
Sliding 10865, 10880
SLX 10668
Smaragd 10487
Soemtron 10865, 11298
Solar Drape 10000
Solavox 10037, 10163, 10361, 10548
Sole 10813
Sonawa 10218
Songba 10009
Soniko 10037
Sonitron 10208, 10217, 10370
Sonneclair 10037
Sonoko 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264
Sonolor 10163, 10208, 10361, 10548
Sontec 10009, 10037, 10370
Sony
10017, 10154, 11100, 10000,
10150, 10053, 10011, 10036,
10037, 10074, 10353, 10650,
11505, 11651, 11751, 11904
Sound & Vision 10218, 10374
Soundesign 10180, 10178
Soundwave 10037, 10418, 10715
Sova 11952
Sowa
10156, 10051, 10060, 10178,
10092, 10036, 10226
Soyea 10773
Spectra 10009
Spectravision 10156, 10178
Spectroniq 11498
Squareview 10171
SR2000 10154, 10171
Ssangyong 10009
SSS 10180
Staksonic 10009
Standard
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10374, 11037
Standard Components
10009, 10218
Starlite
10236, 10180, 10009, 10037,
10163, 10264
Stenway 10218
Stern 10163, 10264
Stevison 11982
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 84 2007/06/20 8:58:55
Strato 10009, 10037, 10264
Strong 11149, 11163
Studio Experience 10843
Stylandia 10217
Sunkai
10218, 10455, 10487, 10610,
10865
Sunstar 10009, 10037, 10264, 10371
Sunwatt 10455
Sunwood 10037
Superla 10217
Superscan 10093, 10864, 11944
Supersonic 10009, 10208, 10455, 10805
SuperTech 10009, 10037, 10218, 10556
Supra 10178, 10009, 10374
Supreme 10000
Susumu 10218, 10287, 10335
Sutron 10009
SV2000 10054
SVA
10748, 10587, 10865, 10870,
10871, 10872
Svasa 10455
Swisstec 10880, 11504
Sydney 10217
Sylvania
10047, 10054, 10154, 10000,
10051, 10178, 10030, 10171,
10092, 10036, 10037, 10876,
11271, 11904, 11944
Symphonic
10000, 10180, 10178, 10171,
11904, 11944
Synco
10000, 10451, 10093, 10060,
10178, 10092, 10036
Syntax 11144, 11240, 11331
Sysline 10037
T
T+A 10447
Tacico 10178, 10092, 10009
Tai Yi 10009
Taishan 10009, 10374, 10817
Tandberg 10109, 10361, 10367
Tandy 10093, 10163, 10217, 10218
Targa 11371
Tashiko
10092, 10036, 10163, 10170,
10217, 10650
Tatung
10054, 10154, 10000, 10156,
10051, 10060, 10037, 10036,
10011, 10009, 10217, 11156,
11191, 11248, 11254, 11371,
11556, 11756
TCL 10706, 10698, 11027, 11537
TCM 10714, 10808
Teac
10154, 10178, 10171, 10706,
11755, 11149, 11037, 10714,
10712, 10698, 10668, 10512,
10455, 10418, 10264, 10217,
10170, 10037, 10009
Tec
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217,
10335
Tech Line 10037, 10668, 11163
Techica 10218
Technica 11982
Technics
10054, 10250, 10051, 10226,
10556, 10650
TechniSat 10556, 11267
Technisson 10714
Technosonic 10499, 10556
Technovox 10030, 10217
Techview 10847
Techwood 10250, 10051, 10060, 11163
Tecnimagen 10556
Teco
10051, 10093, 10178, 10092,
10009, 10036, 10218, 10264,
10653, 11040
Tedelex
10009, 10208, 10217, 10418,
10606, 10698, 11537
Teiron 10009
Tek 10820
Teknika
10054, 10463, 10180, 10150,
10060, 10178, 10092
Tele System
Electronic
10876
Teleavia 10287, 10343
Telecolor 10017
Telecor
10037, 10163, 10217, 10218,
10394
Telefunken
10702, 11504, 10821, 10820,
10819, 10714, 10712, 10698,
10625, 10587, 10560, 10498,
10486, 10346, 10343, 10335,
10287, 10109, 10074, 10073,
10037
Telefusion 10037
Telegazi 10037, 10163, 10218, 10264
Telemeister 10037
Telesonic 10037
Telestar 10009, 10037, 10556
Teletech 10009, 10037, 10668, 11037
Teleton 10036, 10217
Televideon 10163
Teleview 10037
Tempest 10009, 10264, 10455
Tennessee 10037
Tensai
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10371, 10374, 10715, 11037
Tenson 10009
Tera 10030, 10092
Tevion
10037, 10556, 10648, 10668,
10714, 10808, 11037, 11137,
11248, 11298, 11498, 11556
Texet 10009, 10217, 10218, 10374
Texla 10780
ThemeScene 10887
Thomas 10047, 10178, 10001, 11904
Thomson
11447, 10047, 10037, 10109,
10287, 10335, 10343, 10560,
10625
Thorn
10035, 10036, 10037, 10073,
10074, 10109, 10163, 10264,
10335, 10343, 10361, 10499,
10512
Thorn-Ferguson 10073, 10335, 10343, 10499
Tiane 10093, 10817
Tiny 11269
TMK 10236, 10180, 10178
TML 11756
TNCi 10017
Tobishi 10218
Tobo 10748, 10009, 10264
Tocom 10156
Tokai
10009, 10037, 10163, 10217,
10374, 10668, 11037
Tokaido 11037
Tokyo 10035
Tomashi 10218
Tongguang 10264
Tongtel 10587, 10780
Topline 10668, 11037
Toshiba
10154, 11256, 10156, 10150,
11265, 10060, 11145, 10145,
10166, 11037, 11156, 11163,
11164, 11356, 11508, 11556,
11656, 11704, 11945, 11971,
10845, 10821, 10718, 10650,
10618, 10508, 10264, 10217,
10195, 10109, 10070, 10036,
10035, 10011, 10009
Totevision 10051
Towada 10217
Toyoda 10009, 10264, 10371
Toyomenka 10178
Trakton 10217, 10264
Trans Continens 10037, 10217, 10668, 11037
TRANS-continents 10556, 10865
Transonic
10009, 10037, 10264, 10418,
10455, 10512, 10587, 10698,
10712, 10780
Triad 10218, 10556
Trident 10217
Trio 11498
Tristar 10218, 10264
Triumph 10037, 10346, 10556
Truetone 10250, 10051
Tuntex 10030, 10092, 10009
TVS 10463
TVTEXT 95 10556
U
Uher
10037, 10370, 10374, 10418,
10480, 10486
Ultra 10092
Ultravox 10037, 10163, 10374
Unic Line 10037, 10455
United
10037, 10587, 10714, 10715,
11037, 11982
Universal 10047, 10037
Universum
11163, 11037, 10668, 10631,
10618, 10512, 10480, 10418,
10370, 10362, 10361, 10346,
10327, 10264, 10217, 10200,
10195, 10170, 10109, 10074,
10070, 10037, 10036, 10011,
10009
Univox 10037, 10163
V
V 10864, 10885, 11755, 11756
V2max 10865
V7 Videoseven 10880, 11217, 11755
Vector Research 10030
Vestel
10037, 10217, 10668, 11037,
11163
Vexa 10009, 10037
Victor
10250, 10053, 10036, 10650,
10653
Videocon 10508
Videologic 10218
Videologique 10217, 10218
Videomac 10009
VideoSystem 10037
Videotechnic 10217, 10374
Videoton 10163
Vidikron 10054
Vidtech 10178, 10036
Viewpia 10876
Viewsonic
10857, 10864, 10885, 11330,
11578, 11627, 11755
Viking 10060
Viore 11207
Vision 10037, 10217, 10264
Vizio
10864, 10885, 11755, 11756,
11758
Vortec 10037
Voxson 10178, 10037, 10163, 10418
W
Waltham
10037, 10109, 10217, 10418,
10443, 10668, 11037
Wards
10047, 10054, 10017, 10154,
10000, 10156, 10051, 10093,
10236, 10180, 10060, 10178,
10030, 10166, 11347, 11156,
11147, 10866, 10195, 10001,
10037, 10035
Warumaia 10374, 10661
Watson
10009, 10037, 10163, 10218,
10394, 10668, 10714, 11037
Watt Radio 10163
Waycon 10156
Wega 10036, 10037
Wegavox 10009
Weipai 10009
Welltech 10714
Weltblick 10217
Welton 10178
Weltstar 11037
Westinghouse
10000, 10451, 10885, 10889,
11282, 11577
Wharfedale 10037, 10556, 10860, 11556
White
Westinghouse
10451, 10236, 10463, 10037,
10623, 10889, 11909
Windsor 10668, 11037
Windy Sam 10556
Wintel 10714
World 10451, 10236, 10463, 10180
World-of-Vision
10865, 10877, 10880, 11217,
11298
Worldview 10455
X
X-View 11191
Xenius 10634, 10661
Xiahua
10009, 10264, 10698, 10773,
10817
Xianghai 10009
Xiangyang 10264
Xiangyu 10009
Xihu 10264, 10817
Xingfu 10009
Xinghai 10264
XLogic 10698, 10860
Xoceco 11064
Xoro 11196, 11217
XR-1000 10154, 10180, 10171
Xrypton 10037
Y
Yamaha 10030, 10650, 11576
Yamishi 10037, 10217, 10218, 10455
Yapshe 10250
Yingge 10009
Yokan 10037
Yoko
10009, 10037, 10217, 10218,
10264, 10370
Yonggu 10009
Yorx 10030, 10218
Youlanasi 10817
Yousida 10009
Yuhang 10009
Z
Zanussi 10163, 10217, 10264
Zenith
10047, 10017, 10000, 10093,
10463, 11265, 10812, 10178,
10030, 11145, 10145, 10171,
10092, 10037, 11904, 11909,
11911
ZhuHai 10009, 10374
TV/DVD Combination
A
Advent 11933
Akai 11675
Akura 11982
Alba 11037
Amstrad 11982
Apex Digital 11943
Audiovox 11937, 11951, 11952
Axion 11937, 11958
B
Black Diamond 11037
Bush 10698, 11037, 11900
C
Centrum 11037
Crown 11037
D
D-Vision 11982
Denver 10587
PRESET CODE
AVR2808CIEU.indd 85 2007/06/20 8:58:56
E
Elfunk 11037
F
Ferguson 11037
Finlux 11556
G
Goodmans 10587, 11037, 11900
H
Hitachi 11960
J
JDV 11982
Jensen 11933
K
KLH 11962
L
Lenco 10587
Logik 11037
Luker 11982
Luxor 11037
M
Matsui 11037
Maxim 11982
Medion 11900
Mirror 11900
N
Naiko 11982
Narita 11982
P
Panasonic 11941
Philips 11454, 10556, 11961
Powerpoint 10698
Prima 11933
R
RCA 11948, 11958
Roadstar 11900
S
Saivod 11982
Samsung 11903
Schneider 11982
SEG 11037
Sova 11952
Stevison 11982
Sylvania 10171
T
Teac 10698
Technica 11982
Telefunken 10698
Thomson 10625
Transonic 10587
U
United 10587, 11037, 11982
V
Vestel 11037
TV/VCR Combination
A
Aiwa 11904, 11911
America Action 10180
Amstrad 10171
Audiovox 10180
B
Beko 10486
Black Diamond 11909
Broksonic 10463, 11911
Bush 11556
C
Curtis Mathes 10051
D
Daewoo 11909
E
Emerson 10236, 10463, 11909, 11911
F
Ferguson 10073, 10625
Fidelity 10171
Funai 11904
G
GE
10047, 10051, 10093, 11917,
11922
GoldStar 10037
Goodmans 10374, 11909
Grundig 10037, 10195, 10556
H
Harley Davidson 11904
Hinari 10036
Hitachi 11904
I
Internal 11909
J
JVC 11923
L
LG 10178
Lloyd’s 11904
M
Magnavox 10054, 11904
Memorex 10250
Mitsubishi 10093, 10556, 11917
O
Orion 10463, 11911
P
Palsonic 11904
Panasonic 10250, 10051
Penney 10051
Philips 10037, 10556
Q
Quasar 10250, 10051
R
Radiola 10556
RadioShack 11904
RCA
10047, 10051, 10093, 11917,
11922
S
Saba 10625
Samsung 11959
Sansui 10463, 11904, 11911
Schneider 10037, 10556, 11904
Sears 11904
Sharp 10093, 11917
Siemens 10037
Sony 10000, 11505, 11904
Sylvania 10054
Symphonic 11904
T
Teac 10178, 10171
Technics 10556
Thomas 11904
Thomson 10625
Toshiba 11971
W
White
Westinghouse
11909
Z
Zenith 11904, 11909, 11911
TV/VCR/DVD Combination
A
Akai 11903
B
Broksonic 11938
E
Emerson 11944
ESA 11944
M
Magnavox 11944
P
Panasonic 11946, 11947
R
RCA 11953
S
Sharp 11917
Sylvania 11944
Symphonic 11944
T
Toshiba 11945
VCR
A
A-Mark
20037, 20240, 20000, 20278,
20046
ABS 21972
Admiral
20060, 20048, 20039, 20047,
20104, 20121, 20209, 20479
Adventura 20037, 20240, 20000
Aiko 20278
Aim 20278, 20348, 20642
Aiwa
20037, 20032, 20000, 20209,
20041, 20348, 20352, 20479,
20742, 21137
Akai
20037, 20240, 20041, 20106,
20315, 20348, 20352, 20642
Akura 20041
Alba
20081, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20315, 20348, 20352
Alienware 21972
Allegro 20039, 21137
Allorgan 20240
Allstar 20081
America Action 20278
American High 20035, 20081
Amoisonic 20479
Amstrad 20000, 20278
Anam
20162, 20037, 20240, 20278,
20226, 20480
Anam National 20162, 20226, 21162, 21562
Ansonic 20000
Aristona 20081
ASA 20037, 20081
Asha 20240
Astra 20035, 20240
Asuka 20037, 20081, 20000, 20038
Audiolab 20081
Audiosonic 20278
Audiovox 20037, 20278, 20038
Avis 20000
AVP 20000, 20352
Awa 20037, 20043, 20278, 20642
B
Baird
20000, 20104, 20041, 20278,
20046, 20106
Basic Line 20104, 20278, 20046
Beaumark 20240
Beko 20104
Bell & Howell
20035, 20048, 20039, 20000,
20104, 20046, 20479
Bestar 20278
Black Diamond 20642
Black Panther 20278
Blaupunkt 20162, 20081, 20226
Blue Sky
20037, 20209, 20278, 20348,
20352, 20480, 20642, 20742,
21137
BPL 20046
Brandt 20041, 20320
Brandt Electronique 20041
Brinkmann 20209, 20348
Broksonic
20184, 20121, 20209, 20002,
20348, 20479, 21479
Bush
20081, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20315, 20348, 20352, 20642,
20742
C
Calix 20037
Candle 20037, 20038
Canon 20035
Capehart 20002
Carena 20081, 20209
Carrefour 20045
Carrera 20240
Carver 20035, 20081
Casio 20000
Cathay 20278
CCE 20278
CGE 20000, 20041
Changhong 20048, 20081
Cimline 20209
Cineral 20278
CineVision 21137
Citizen
20035, 20037, 20240, 20000,
20209, 20278, 20479, 21278
Classic 20037
Clatronic 20000, 21593
Colortyme 20060, 20035, 20045, 20278
Colt 20000
Combitech 20352
Condor 20278
Craig 20037, 20047, 20240
Criterion 20000
Crosley 20035, 20081, 20000
Crown 20037, 20278, 20480
Curtis Mathes
20060, 20035, 20162, 20240,
20000, 20041, 20278, 20432,
21035
Cybernex 20240
CyberPower 21972
Cyrus 20081
D
Daewoo
20037, 20045, 20104, 20209,
20278, 20046, 20352, 20637,
20642, 21137, 21278
Dansai 20278
Dantax 20352
Daytron 20037, 20278
De Graaf
20048, 20081, 20042, 20104,
20046
Decca
20081, 20000, 20067, 20209,
20041, 20352
Degraff 20048, 20081, 20042, 20104
Deitron 20278
Dell 21972
Denon 20081, 20042
Derwent 20041
Diamant 20037
Diamond 20348
Digitor 20642
DirecTV 20739
Domland 20209
DSE 20642
Dual
20081, 20000, 20041, 20278,
20348
Dumont 20081, 20000, 20104
Durabrand 20039, 20038, 20642
Dynatech 20240, 20000
E
Elbe 20278, 20038
Electrohome
20060, 20037, 20240, 20000,
20043, 20209
Electrophonic 20037
Elin 20240
Elta 20278
Emerald 20184, 20121
Emerex 20032
Emerson
20035, 20037, 20184, 20039,
20240, 20045, 20000, 20121,
20043, 20209, 20002, 20278,
20348, 20479, 20637, 21278,
21479, 21593
ESA 21137
ESC 20240, 20278
EuroLine 21593
F
Ferguson
20000, 20041, 20278, 20320,
20348
Fidelity 20240, 20000, 20352, 20432
Finlandia
20037, 20048, 20081, 20000,
20042, 20104, 20043, 20046,
20106, 20226
Finlux 20081, 20000, 20042, 20104
Firstline
20037, 20045, 20042, 20043,
20209, 20278, 20348, 20480,
21137
Fisher
20039, 20047, 20000, 20104,
20046
Flint 20209, 20348
Fuji 20035, 20033
Fujitsu 20037, 20045, 20000
Fujitsu General 20037
Funai 20037, 20000, 20278, 21593
G
Galaxi 20000
Galaxis 20278
Garrard 20000
Gateway 21972
PRESET CODE
0
AVR2808CIEU.indd 86 2007/06/20 8:58:58
GE
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20000, 20226, 20320, 20807,
21035, 21060
GEC 20081
Gemini 20060
General 20045
General Technic 20348
Genexxa 20037, 20000, 20104, 20278
Go Video 20240, 20432, 20614, 21137
GoldStar
20035, 20037, 20039, 20000,
20209, 20278, 20038, 20225,
20226, 20480, 21137, 21237
Goodmans
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20209, 20278, 20348, 20352,
20637, 20642, 20742
GPX 20037
Gradiente 20000
Graetz 20240, 20104, 20041
Granada
20035, 20037, 20048, 20081,
20240, 20000, 20042, 20104,
20046, 20226
Grandin
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20742
Grundig
20081, 20226, 20320, 20347,
20348, 20352, 20742
H
Haaz 20348
Hanimex 20352
Hanseatic 20037, 20081, 20209, 20038
Haojie 20240
Harley Davidson 20000
Harman/Kardon 20081, 20038
Headquarter 20046
Hewlett Packard 21972
HI-Q 20035, 20047, 20000
Hinari
20240, 20209, 20041, 20278,
20352
Hisawa 20209, 2035
Hischito 20045
Hitachi
20035, 20037, 20081, 20240,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20041,
20046, 20089
Hoeher 20278, 20642
Hornyphon 20081
Howard Computers 21972
HP 21972
Hughes Network
Systems
20042, 20739
Humax 20739
Hush 21972
Hypson
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20352, 20480
Hytek 20047, 20000
I
iBUYPOWER 21972
Imperial 20000
Ingersol 20240, 20209
Interbuy 20037
Interfunk 20081, 20104
Internal 20278, 20637
International 20037, 20278, 20642
Intervision
20037, 20000, 20209, 20278,
20348
Irradio 20037, 20081, 21137
ITT
20240, 20104, 20041, 20046,
20106
ITT Nokia 20240, 20104, 20041, 20106
ITV 20037, 20278
J
Janeil 20240
JBL 20278
Jensen 20067, 20041
JMB 20209, 20348, 20352, 20742
Joyce 20000
JVC
20184, 20081, 20045, 20067,
20041, 21162
K
Kambrook 20037
Karcher 20081, 20278, 20642
KEC 20037, 20278
Kendo
20037, 20209, 20278, 20106,
20315, 20348, 20642
Kenwood 20067, 20041, 20038, 20046
KIC 20000
Kimari 20047
Kneissel
20037, 20209, 20278, 20348,
20352
Kodak 20035, 20037
Kolin 20043, 20041
Kolster 20209
KTV 20000
Kuba 20047
Kuba Electronic 20047
L
Lenco 20278
LG
20037, 20240, 20045, 20000,
20042, 20209, 20278, 20038,
20225, 20480, 21137, 21237
Lifetec 20209, 20348
Linksys 21972
Lloyd’s 20240, 20000, 20038
Loewe
21062, 20162, 20037, 20081,
21262, 21562
Logik 20240, 20000, 20209, 20106
Lumatron 20278, 21137
Lunatron 21137
Luxor
20048, 20047, 20104, 20043,
20046, 20106, 20315
LXI 20037, 20000, 20042, 20067
M
M Electronic 20037, 20240, 20000, 20038
Magnadyne 20081
Magnasonic
20037, 20240, 20000, 20278,
21278
Magnavox
20035, 20037, 20048, 20039,
20081, 20240, 20000, 20226,
20618, 20642, 21593, 21781
Magnin 20240
Magnum 20642
Manesth 20081, 20045, 20209
Marantz 20035, 20081, 20209, 20038
Mark 20000, 20278
Marta 20037
Mastec 20642
Master’s 20278
Matsui
20037, 20240, 20209, 20278,
20348, 20352, 20742
Matsushita
20035, 20162, 20081, 20226,
21162
Media Center PC 21972
Mediator 20081
Medion 20209, 20348, 20352, 20642
MEI 20035
Memorex
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048,
20039, 20047, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20209, 20278, 20046,
20348, 20479, 21162, 21237,
21262
Metronic 20081
Metz
21062, 20162, 20037, 20081,
20226, 20347, 20836, 21162,
21262, 21562
MGA 20060, 20240, 20043
MGN Technology 20240
Micormay 20348
Micromaxx 20209
Microsoft 21972
Midland 20240
Migros 20000
Mind 21972
Minolta 20042
Mitsubishi
20060, 20048, 20047, 20081,
20000, 20042, 20067, 20043,
20041, 20480, 20642, 20807
Motorola 20035, 20048
MTC 20240, 20000
MTX 20000
Multitec 20037
Multitech 20039, 20000
Murphy 20000
Myryad 20081
N
NAD 20240, 20104
Naiko 20348, 20642
NAP 20039
National 20226
Nebula Electronics 20033
NEC
20035, 20037, 20048, 20104,
20067, 20041, 20278, 20038,
21137
Neckermann 20081, 20041
Nesco 20000
Neufunk 20209
Newave 20037
Nikkai 20278
Nikko 20037, 20278
Nikkodo 20037, 20278
Nishi 20240
Niveus Media 21972
Noblex 20240
Nokia
20048, 20081, 20240, 20042,
20104, 20041, 20278, 20046,
20106, 20315
Nordmende 20067, 20041, 20320
Northgate 21972
Nu-Tec 20209
O
Oceanic
20048, 20081, 20000, 20104,
20041, 20046, 20106
Okano 20209, 20278, 20315, 20348
Olympus 20035, 20162, 20104, 20226
Onimax 20642
Onkyo 20222
Optimus
21062, 20035, 20162, 20037,
20048, 20047, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20432, 21162, 21262
Orion
20184, 20240, 20000, 20104,
20121, 20209, 20002, 20278,
20348, 20352, 20479, 20742,
21479
Orson 20000
Osaki 20037, 20000
Otake 20209
Otto Versand 20081
P
Pace 20352
Pacific 20000, 20348, 20642, 20742
Packard Bell 21972
Palladium 20037, 20209, 20041, 20348
Palsonic 20000, 20642
Panama 20035
Panasonic
21062, 20035, 20162, 20000,
20225, 20226, 20614, 20616,
20836, 21035, 21162, 21262,
21562
Pathe Cinema 20043
Pathe Marconi 20041
Penney
20035, 20162, 20037, 20047,
20081, 20240, 20000, 20042,
20067, 20038, 21035, 21237
Pentax 20042
Perdio 20000, 20209
Philco
20035, 20081, 20000, 20209,
20038, 20226, 20479
Philips
20035, 20162, 20048, 20081,
20045, 20000, 20209, 20226,
20616, 20618, 20739, 21081,
21181
Phoenix 20278
Phonola 20081
Pilot 20037
Pioneer 20162, 20081, 20042, 20067
Polk Audio 20081
Portland 20278, 20637
Presidian 21593
Prinz 20000
Profitronic 20081, 20240
Proline 20000, 20278, 20320, 20642
Proscan 20060, 21060
Prosco 20278
Prosonic 20209, 20278
Protec 20000
Protech 20081
ProVision 20278
Pulsar 20039, 20240, 20278
Pulser 20240
Pye 20081, 20000
Q
Qisheng 20060
Quarter 20046
Quartz 20035, 20047, 20046
Quasar
20035, 20162, 20002, 20278,
20226, 21035, 21162
Quelle 20081
R
Radialva 20037, 20048, 20081
Radiola 20081
Radionette 20037, 21137
RadioShack
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048,
20047, 20240, 20000, 20104,
20046, 21162
Radix 20037
Randex 20037
Rank 20041
Rank Arena 20041
RCA
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20106,
20226, 20320, 20807, 20880,
21035, 21060
Realistic
20035, 20162, 20037, 20048,
20047, 20240, 20000, 20104,
20121, 20278, 20046, 21162
Reoc 20348
ReplayTV 20614, 20616
Rex 20041
Ricavision 21972
Rio 21137
Roadstar
20037, 20081, 20240, 20278,
20038, 20742
Runco 20039
S
Saba 20041, 20278, 20320
Saisho 20209, 20348
Salora 20104, 20043, 20046, 20106
Sampo 20037, 20048
Samsung
20060, 20240, 20045, 20000,
20038, 20432, 20739, 21014
Samtron 20240
Sanky 20048, 20039
Sansei 20048
Sansui
20240, 20000, 20067, 20209,
20041, 20002, 20106, 20348,
20479, 21479
Sanyo
20048, 20047, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20067, 20209, 20046,
20348, 20479, 21137
Saville 20240, 20278, 20352
SBR 20081
ScanSonic 20240
PRESET CODE

AVR2808CIEU.indd 87 2007/06/20 8:58:59
Schaub Lorenz
20000, 20104, 20041, 20106,
20315, 20348
Schneider
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20042, 20278, 20348, 20352,
20642, 21137
Scott 20184, 20045, 20121, 20043
Sears
20060, 20035, 20162, 20037,
20048, 20039, 20047, 20033,
20045, 20000, 20042, 20104,
20067, 20043, 20209, 20041,
21237, 20046
Seaway 20278
SEG
20081, 20240, 20278, 20637,
20642
SEI 20081
Sei-Sinudyne 20081
Seleco 20037, 20041
Semp 20045
Sentra 20278
Sharp
20037, 20048, 20047, 20032,
20000, 20209, 20807
Shinco 20000
Shintom 20039, 20240, 20000, 20104
Shivaki 20037
Shogun 20240
Siemens
20037, 20081, 20104, 20046,
20320, 20347
Siera 20081
Signature
20060, 20035, 20037, 20048,
20000, 20046, 20479
Silva 20037
Silver 20278
SilverCrest 20642
Singer 20037, 20240, 20045, 20348
Sinudyne 20081, 20209, 20352
Smaragd 20348
Sonic Blue 20614, 20616, 21137
Sonographe 20046
Sonolor 20048, 20046
Sontec 20037, 20278
Sonwa 20642
Sony
20035, 20048, 20047, 20032,
20033, 20000, 20067, 20046,
20106, 20226, 20636, 21232,
21972
Soundmaster 20000
Soundwave 20037, 20209, 20348
Stack 9 21972
Standard 20278
Stern 20278
STS 20042
Sunkai 20209, 20278, 20348
Sunstar 20000
Suntronic 20000
Supra 20037, 20278, 20348
Susumu 20037
SV2000 20000
SVA 20000
Sylvania
20035, 20081, 20000, 20043,
21593, 21781
Symphonic 20240, 20000, 20002, 21593
Systemax 21972
T
T+A 20162
Tagar Systems 21972
Taisho 20209
Tandberg 20278
Tandy 20000, 20104
Tashiko
20037, 20048, 20081, 20240,
20000
Tatung
20048, 20081, 20045, 20000,
20067, 20043, 20209, 20041,
20348, 20352
Tchibo 20348
TCM 20348
Teac
20037, 20000, 20067, 20041,
20278, 20637, 20642, 21593
Technics
20035, 20162, 20037, 20081,
20000, 20226, 21162
TechniSat 20348
Technosonic 20352
Teco
20035, 20037, 20048, 20041,
20038
Tedelex 20037, 20209, 20348, 20642
Teknika 20035, 20037, 20000
Teleavia 20041
Telecorder 20240
Telefunken
20209, 20041, 20278, 20320,
20642
Telerent 20226
Telestar 20037
Teletech 20000, 20278
Tensai 20037, 20000, 20278
Tevion 20209, 20348, 20479, 20642
Texet 20278
Thomas 20000, 20002
Thomson
20060, 20067, 20041, 20278,
20320
Thorn 20037, 20104, 20041, 20320
Tisonic 20278
Tivo 20618, 20636, 20739, 21996
TMK 20240, 20000
TNIX 20037
Tocom 20240
Tokai 20037, 20104, 20041
Topline 20348
Toshiba
20081, 20240, 20045, 20000,
20042, 20067, 20043, 20209,
20041, 20352, 20432, 20742,
20845, 21008, 21145, 21972,
21996
Tosonic 20278
Totevision 20037, 20240
Touch 21972
Toyoda 20278
Tradex 20081
Triad 20278
Trix 20037
U
Uher 20240
Ultra 20045, 20278
Ultravox 20278
Unitech 20240
United 20348, 20742, 21593
Universum
20037, 20081, 20240, 20000,
20104, 20209, 20106, 20348,
21137
V
Vector 20045
Vector Research 20184, 20038
Victor 20067, 20041
Video Concepts 20045
Video Technic 20000
Videomagic 20037
Videosonic 20240, 20000
Viewsonic 21972
Villain 20000
Voodoo 21972
W
Wards
20060, 20035, 20037, 20048,
20039, 20047, 20081, 20033,
20240, 20045, 20000, 20042,
20043, 20041, 20038, 20046,
20479
Watson 20081, 20352, 20642
Weltblick 20037
Wharfedale 20642
White
Westinghouse
20000, 20209, 20278, 20479,
20637
World 20209, 20002, 20348, 20479
X
XR-1000 20035, 20240, 20000
Y
Yamaha 20041, 20038
Yamishi 20278
Yoko 20037, 20240
Z
Zenith
20037, 20039, 20033, 20000,
20209, 20041, 20278, 20479,
20637, 21137, 21479
ZT Group 21972
ZX 20209, 20348, 20352
DBS/PVR Combination
H
Hughes Network
Systems
20739
P
Philips 20739
S
Samsung 20739
PVR
A
ABS 21972
Alienware 21972
C
CyberPower 21972
D
Dell 21972
DirecTV 20739
G
Gateway 21972
Go Video 20614
H
Hewlett Packard 21972
Howard Computers 21972
HP 21972
Hughes Network
Systems
20739
Humax 20739
Hush 21972
I
iBUYPOWER 21972
L
Linksys 21972
M
Media Center PC 21972
Microsoft 21972
Mind 21972
N
Niveus Media 21972
Northgate 21972
P
Panasonic 20614, 20616
Philips 20618, 20739
R
RCA 20880
ReplayTV 20614, 20616
S
Samsung 20739
Sonic Blue 20614, 20616
Sony 20636, 21972
Stack 9 21972
Systemax 21972
T
Tagar Systems 21972
Tivo 20618, 20636, 20739
Toshiba 21008, 21972, 21996
Touch 21972
V
Viewsonic 21972
Voodoo 21972
Z
ZT Group 21972
TV/VCR Combination
A
Aiwa
20000, 20352, 20479, 20742,
21137
Akai 20352
Alba 20352
America Action 20278
Amstrad 20000
Audiovox 20278
B
Beko 20104
Bestar 20278
Blue Sky 20278, 20352, 20742
BPL 20046
Broksonic 20002, 20479, 21479
Bush 20352, 20742
C
Citizen 20278, 21278
Curtis Mathes 20035, 21035
D
Daewoo 20278, 20637, 21278
Dantax 20352
E
Emerson
20002, 20278, 20479, 20637,
21278, 21479
F
Ferguson 20000, 20278
Fidelity 20000
Firstline 20278
Funai 20000
G
GE
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20807, 21035, 21060
GoldStar 20037, 20480, 21237
Goodmans 20278, 20352, 20637
Grandin 20278, 20742
Grundig 20081, 20347, 20352, 20742
H
Hanimex 20352
Harley Davidson 20000
Hinari 20352
Hitachi 20000
Hypson 20037
I
Internal 20278, 20637
J
JBL 20278
JMB 20352
K
Kambrook 20037
Kneissel 20278, 20352
L
LG 20037, 20480, 21237
Lloyd’s 20000
Loewe 20037
M
Magnasonic 20278, 21278
Magnavox 20081, 20000, 21781
Magnin 20240
Matsui 20352, 20742
Medion 20352
Memorex
20162, 20037, 21162, 21237,
21262
MGA 20240
Mitsubishi 20048, 20081, 20043, 20807
O
Optimus 20162, 21162, 21262
Orion
20002, 20352, 20479, 20742,
21479
P
Pace 20352
Pacific 20742
Palsonic 20000
Panasonic
20035, 20162, 21035, 21162,
21262
Penney
20035, 20037, 20240, 21035,
21237
Philips 20081
Portland 20637
Q
Quasar 20035, 20162, 21035, 21162
R
Radiola 20081
RadioShack 20000
RCA
20060, 20035, 20048, 20240,
20807, 21035, 21060
S
Saba 20320
Samsung 20240, 20432, 21014
Sansui 20000, 20479, 21479
Sanyo 20240
Saville 20352
Schneider 20081, 20000
PRESET CODE

AVR2808CIEU.indd 88 2007/06/20 8:59:00
Sears 20037, 20000, 21237
SEG 20637
Sharp 20037, 20048, 20807
Shivaki 20037
Siemens 20081
Sinudyne 20352
Sony 20032, 20000, 21232
Supra 20348
Sylvania 20081, 21781
Symphonic 20000
T
Tatung 20352
Teac 20037, 20000, 20637, 20642
Technics 20081
Technosonic 20352
Telefunken 20278
Thomas 20000
Thomson 20278
Toshiba 20352, 20432, 20845, 21145
U
United 20742
W
White
Westinghouse
20278, 20637
Z
Zenith 20000, 20479, 20637, 21479
TV/VCR/DVD Combination
S
Sharp 20807
DVD Player
1
3D LAB 30503, 30539
4Kus 31158
A
A-Trend 30714
Acoustic Solutions 30713, 30730, 31228
AEG 30770, 30788, 30790, 31923
AFK 31051, 31152, 31923
Aim 30672, 30699, 30833
Airis
30672, 31005, 31224, 31250,
31321, 31345
Aiwa 30533, 30641
Akai
30690, 30695, 30705, 30770,
30788, 30790, 30884, 30898,
30899, 31115, 31205, 31233,
31695
Akashi 30838
AKI 31005
Akira 30699, 31321
Akura
30898, 31051, 31140, 31233,
31367
Alba
30672, 30539, 30717, 30695,
30699, 30713, 30730, 30783,
30884, 31140, 31530, 31695
Alco 30790
Alize 31151
All-Tel 31451
Allegro 30869
Altacom 31224
Amitech 30784, 30770, 30850
Amoi 30852
Amphion Media
Works
30872
Amstrad 30713, 30770, 31151, 31367
AMW 30872
Anam 31913
Ansonic 30759, 30774, 30831
Apex Digital
30533, 30672, 30717, 30755,
30794, 30796, 30797, 30830,
31004, 31020, 31056, 31061
Aristona 30539, 30646
Arrgo 31023
ASCOMTEC 31923
Asono 31224
Aspire Digital 31168
Atacom 31224
Audiosonic 30690, 31923
Audiovox 30717, 30790
Audioworld 30790
Autovox 30713
Auvio 30843
Awa 30730, 30872
Axion 30730
B
Base 31451
Basic Line 30713
Baze 30898
BBK 30862, 31224
Beep 31163
Bellagio 31004
Belson 31086, 31923
Binatone 31923
Black Diamond 30713, 30833, 30884
Blaupunkt 30717
Blu:sens 31233, 31321
Blue Nova
International
31321
Blue Parade 30571
Blue Sky
30672, 30651, 30695, 30699,
30713, 30790, 30843, 31423
Boghe 31004
Boman 30783, 30898, 31005
Bose 32023
Brainwave 30770, 31115
Brandt 30503, 30651, 30551
Broksonic 30695
Bush
30672, 30717, 30690, 30699,
30713, 30723, 30730, 30831,
30833, 30884, 31051, 31140,
31483, 31695, 31832
Byd:sign 30872
C
C-Tech 30798, 31152
California Audio Labs
30490
Cambridge Audio 30751, 31109
Cambridge
Soundworks
30690
Campomatic Digital 31051
Cat 30699, 30789, 31421, 31923
CCE 30730
Celestial 31020
cello 31730
Centrex 30672, 31004
Centrum
30713, 30789, 31005, 31227,
31923
CGV 30751, 31115
Changhong 30627, 31061
Cinea 30831, 30841
Cinetec 30713, 30872
cineULTRA 30699
CineVision 30833, 30869, 31483
Citizen 30695
Clairtone 30571
Classic 30730, 31730
Clatronic 30672, 30675, 30788, 31233
Clayton 30713
Coby
30730, 30852, 31086, 31321,
31923
Codex 31233
Commax 31321
Conia 30672, 30852, 31321
Contel 30788
Continental Edison 30831, 30872
Craig 30831
Creative 30503, 30539
Crown 30690, 30713, 30770, 31115
Crypto 31228
Curtis Mathes 31087
Cybercom 30831
CyberHome
30714, 30816, 30874, 31023,
31024, 31117, 31129, 31502
Cytron 30651, 30705, 30774, 31347
D
D-Vision 31115, 31367
Daenyx 30872
Daewoo
30490, 30784, 30705, 30714,
30770, 30833, 30869, 30872,
31172, 31483, 31906
Dalton 31036
Dansai 30770, 30783, 31115, 31695
Dantax 30539, 30713, 30723, 30790
Daytek 30872, 31005
Dayton 30872
DCE 30831
Decca 30770, 31115
Denon
30490, 30634, 31634,
[32134]
z
Denver
30672, 30699, 30788, 30898,
31056, 31104, 31321, 31923
Denzel 30665
Desay 30843, 31212
Dgtec 30672
Diamond 30651, 30751, 30768, 30790
Digihome 30713
DigiLogic 30713
digiRED 30717
Digitech 31832
Digitor
30651, 30690, 30833, 31005,
31423
Digitrex 30672, 31004, 31056
DiK 30831
Dinamic 30788
Disney 30675, 30831, 31270
DiViDo 30705
DK Digital 30831
DMTech 30783, 31271
Dragon 30831
DreamX 31151
DSE 30833, 31152, 31730
Dual
30651, 30665, 30675, 30713,
30730, 30783, 30790, 30831,
31023
Durabrand 30713, 30831, 31023, 31502
DVD2000 30521
DVX 30768
E
E:max 31233, 31321
EagleTec 30714
eBench 31152
ECC 30730
Eclipse 30723, 30751
Elfunk 30713, 30850, 30884
Elin 30770
Elite 31152
Ellion 30850, 31421
Elta
30672, 30690, 30770, 30788,
30850, 31051, 31115, 31151,
31233
Eltax 31233, 31321
Emerson
30591, 30675, 30705, 30821,
31268
Enterprise 30591
Entivo 30503, 30539
Enzer 30784, 30770, 31228
ESA 30821, 31268
EuroLine 30675, 30788, 31115, 31233
F
Fenner 30651
Ferguson
30651, 30695, 30713, 30884,
30898, 31695, 31730
Finlux
30672, 30591, 30741, 30751,
30770, 30783
Firstline
30651, 30713, 30843, 30869,
31530
Fisher 30670
Funai 30675, 30695, 31268
Fusion 30862
G
Gateway 31158
GE 30522, 30815, 30717
General Electric 30717
Germatic 31051
Global Link 31224
Global Solutions 30768
Global Sphere 31152
Go Video
30573, 30744, 30717, 30715,
30741, 30783, 30833, 30869,
31044, 31075, 31099, 31158,
31483, 31730
GoldStar 30591, 30741, 30869
Goodmans
30651, 30690, 30713, 30723,
30730, 30783, 30790, 30833,
31004, 31140, 31423, 31530,
31730, 31923
GP Audio 31140
GPX 30699, 30741
Gradiente 30490, 30651
Graetz 30665
Gran Prix 30831, 30898
Grandin 30713, 31233
Greenhill 30717
Grundig
30539, 30651, 30551, 30670,
30686, 30695, 30705, 30713,
30775, 30790, 31004, 31036,
31695, 31730, 31832, 31920
Grunkel 30770, 30790, 30831
H
H & B
30713, 30841, 30850, 31233,
31421
Haaz 30751, 31152
Haier 30843
Hanseatic 30741, 30783, 30790
Harman/Kardon 30582, 30702
HCM 30788
HDT 30705
HE 30730, 31163, 31923
Henss 30713
HiMAX 30843
Hitachi
30573, 30664, 30665, 30713,
31247, 31920
Hiteker 30672, 31923
Hoeher
30651, 30713, 30831, 31004,
31224
Home Electronics 30730, 30770
Home Tech Industries
31224
Hoyo 30665
Humax 30646
Hyundai 30783, 30850, 31061, 31228
I
iLo 31348
Ingelen 30788
Ingersol 31023
Initial 30839, 30717
Inno Hit 30713
Insignia 31268
Integra 30571, 30627, 31634
Irradio 30869, 31115, 31224, 31233
IRT 30783
ISP 30695
J
Jamo 31036
PRESET CODE

AVR2808CIEU.indd 89 2007/06/20 8:59:02
Jaton 30665
JBL 30702
JDB 30730
JDV 31367
Jeken 30699
Jepssen 31250
JMB 30695
JNC 30672, 31271
JSI 31423
JVC
30503, 30539, 30558, 30623,
30867, 31164, 31597, 31860
jWin 31051
K
Kansas Technologies 31233, 31530
Karcher 30783
Kawasaki 30790
Kendo 30672, 30699, 30713, 30831
Kennex 30713, 30770, 30898
Kenwood 30490, 30534
Kiiro 30770
Kiss 30665, 30841, 31523
KLH 30815, 30717, 30790, 31020
Kloss 30533
Koda 31230
Konka 31192
Koss 30651, 31061, 31423
Kreisen 31421
KXD 31321, 31923
L
Lasonic 30627, 30798, 30789
Lawson 30768
Lecson 31533
Leiker 30872
Lenco
30651, 30699, 30713, 30770,
30774
Lenoir 31228
Lenoxx 30690, 30838
Lexia 30699, 30768
LG
30591, 30741, 30790, 30869,
31906
Lifetec 30651, 30831, 31347
Limit 30768, 31104
LiteOn 31058, 31158
Lodos 30713
Loewe 30539, 30511, 30741, 30885
Logik 30713, 30884
Logix 30705, 30783
Luker 31367
Lumatron
30695, 30705, 30713, 30741,
30833, 31115, 31321, 31832
Lunatron 30741
Luxman 30573
Luxor 30713, 31004, 31695, 31730
M
Magnasonic 30651, 30675
Magnat 31923
Magnavox
30503, 30539, 30646, 30675,
30713, 30821, 30885, 31140,
31268
Magnex 30723
Majestic 31345
Manhattan 30705, 30713
Marantz 30503, 30539, 30675
Mark 30713
Marquant 30770
Matsui
30672, 30651, 30695, 30713,
30884, 31004, 31695, 31730
Maxdorf 30788
Maxent 31347
Maxim 30713, 30872, 31367
Maya 31345
MBO 30690, 30730, 31730
McIntosh 31533
MDS 30713
Mecotek 30770
Medion
30651, 30630, 30774, 30783,
30831, 31006, 31270, 31345,
31347, 31423
MEI 30790
Memorex 30690, 30695, 30831, 31270
Metronic 30690
Metz 30525, 30571, 30713
MiCO 30723, 30751, 31223
Micromaxx 31695
Micromedia 30503, 30539
Micromega 30539, 31005
Microsoft 30522, 31708
Microstar 30831
Minato 30752
Minax 30713
Minerva 30705
Minoka 30770, 31115
Mintek 30839, 30717
Mirror 30752
Mitsubishi 31521, 30521, 30713, 31403
Mizuda 30770, 31451
Monyka 30665
MPX 30843
Mustek 30730, 31730
Mx Onda 30651, 30751, 31223
Mystral 30831
N
NAD 30741
Naiko 30770, 31004, 31367
Narita 31367
NEC 30741, 30869, 31404
Neovia 31271
Nesa 30717
Neufunk 30665
Nevir 30770, 30831, 31197
NexxTech 31402
Nikkai 31923
Nintaus 31051, 31202
Niro 32024
Norcent 30872, 31923
Nordmende 30774, 30831
Noriko 30752
Nova 31923
Nowa 30843
Nu-Tec 31228
O
Okano 30752
Olidata 30672
Omni
30690, 30833, 30838, 30862,
31104, 31832
Onix 30838
Onkyo 30503, 30627
Oopla 31158
Oppo 31224
Optim 30843
Optimus 30525, 30571
Orbit 30872
Orion 30695, 31233, 31695
Oritron 30651
Ormond 30713
P
P&B 31451
Pacific
30695, 30713, 30759, 30768,
30790, 30831
Packard Bell 30831
Palladium 30695, 30713, 31906, 31920
Palsonic 30672, 30852, 31056, 31321
Panasonic
30503, 30490, 30571, 30703,
31362, 31462, 31490, 31579,
31762, 31834, 31905, 31908
Panda 30717, 30789, 31203
peeKTon 30898, 31224
Philco 30690, 30862
Philips
30503, 30539, 30646, 30675,
30854, 30885, 31158, 31260,
31267, 31340, 31354
Philo 31345
Phonotrend 30699
PianoDisc 31024
Pioneer
30490, 30525, 30571, 30631,
31965
Plu2 30850
Pointer 30784
Polaroid 31020, 31061, 31086
Polk Audio 30539
Portland 30770
Powerpoint 30872, 31005
Presidian 30675
Prima 31228
Prinz 30831
Prism 30705, 30831
Pro2 31345
ProCaster 31004
Proceed 30672
Proline
30672, 30651, 30686, 30833,
31004, 31483
Proscan 30522
Proson 30713
Prosonic 30699, 30752
ProVision
30699, 30730, 31163, 31321,
31923
Pye 30539, 30646
Q
QONIX 31051
Qwestar 30651
R
Radionette 30741, 30869, 31906, 32024
RadioShack 30571
Raite 30665
RCA
30522, 30571, 30717, 30790,
30822, 31022, 31132, 31769,
31913, 31965
Realistic 30571
REC 30490
Redstar
30759, 30763, 30770, 30788,
30898, 31345, 31923
Relisys 31347
Reoc 30752, 30768
Revoy 30699, 30841
Rex 30838
Richmond 31233
Rio 30869
Roadstar
30672, 30690, 30699, 30713,
30730, 30833, 30898, 31051,
31227
Rocksonic 30789
Ronin 30872
Rotel 30558, 30623
Rowa 30717, 30759, 30872, 31004
Rownsonic 30789
S
Saba 30651, 3055
Sabaki 30798
Saivod 30759, 30831, 31367
Salora 30741
Sampo 30752, 31321, 31347
Samsung
30490, 30573, 30744, 30199,
30820, 30899, 31044, 31075,
31635, 31932
Sansui
30784, 30695, 30751, 30763,
30768, 31051, 31228, 31230,
31695, 31832
Sanyo
30670, 30675, 30695, 30713,
30873, 31228
Scan 30705, 30850
ScanMagic 30730, 31730
ScanSonic 31695
Schaub Lorenz 30770, 30788, 31115, 31151
Schneider
30539, 30646, 30651, 30705,
30713, 30774, 30783, 30788,
30790, 30831, 30869, 31367
Schwaiger 30752
Scientific Labs 30768
Scott
30672, 30651, 31005, 31036,
31233, 31423
Seeltech 31224, 31451
SEG
30798, 30665, 30713, 30763,
30872, 30884, 31483, 31530
Sensory Science 31158
Shanghai 30672
Sharp
30630, 30675, 30713, 30752,
31256, 32015, 32024
Sharper Image 31117
Sherwood 30717, 30741, 30770
Shinco 30717
Shinsonic 30533, 30839
Siemssen 31382
Sigmatek 31005, 31224
Siltex 31224
Silva 30788, 30898
Silva Schneider 30831, 30898
SilverCrest 31152
Simaudio 30885
Singer 30690, 30751, 30768
Sistemas 30672
Skantic 30539, 30713
Skymaster 30730, 30768
Skyworth 30898
Sliding 31115
Slim Art 30784
SM Electronic 30690, 30730, 30768, 31152
Smart 30705, 30713
Sonai 30755
Sonashi 30831
Sonic Blue
30573, 30715, 30783, 30869,
31099
Sony
30533, 31533, 30864, 30573,
30630, 30772, 31033, 31070,
31431, 31433, 31536, 31633,
31769, 31981, 32043
Sound Color 31233
Soundmaster 30768
Soundmax 30768
Soundwave 30783
Spectra 30872
Standard
30651, 30768, 30788, 30831,
30898
Star Clusters 31152, 31227
Starlogic 31005
Starmedia 31005, 31224
Stevison 31367
Strong 30713
Sunkai 30770, 30850
Sunstech 30831
Sunwood 30788, 30898
Superscan 30821
Supervision 30768, 31152
SVA 30672, 30717, 30752, 31105
PRESET CODE

AVR2808CIEU.indd 90 2007/06/20 8:59:03
Sylvania 30630, 30675, 30821, 31268
Symphonic 30675, 30821, 31268
Synn 30768
T
Tandberg 30713, 31695
Tangent 31321
Targa 31227
Tatung 30770, 31695
Tchibo 30741
TCL 31180
TCM 30741, 30790
Teac
30571, 30717, 30675, 30741,
30759, 30768, 30790, 30833,
31006, 31197, 31227
Tec 30898
Technica 31367, 31695
Technics 30490, 30703, 31905
Technika 30770, 30831, 31115, 31695
Technisson 31115
Technosonic 30730, 31051, 31115
Techwood 30713, 31530
Tedelex 30690, 30768, 31004, 31228
Telefunken
30789, 30790, 30833, 31483,
31832, 31923
Teletech 30713, 30768
Tensai 30651, 30690, 30770
Tevion
30651, 30798, 30768, 30833,
30898, 31036, 31227, 31347,
31382, 31483, 31730, 31923
Theta Digital 30571
Thomson 30522, 30511, 30551
Tivo 31503
Tokai
30784, 30665, 30788, 30790,
30898
Tom-Tec 30789
Top Suxess 31224
Toshiba
30503, 30573, 30539, 30695,
31045, 31154, 31503, 31510,
31769
TRANS-continents 30831, 30872, 31321, 31327
Transonic 30730
Tredex 30843
TruVision 31451
Tsinghua Tongfang 31205
TSM 31224
U
Umax 30690, 31151
Unimax 30770
United
30675, 30695, 30699, 30713,
30730, 30788, 30884, 31115,
31152, 31228, 31367, 31832
Universum
30591, 30713, 30741, 30790,
30869, 31227, 31530, 31913
Uptek 30763
upXus 31345
Urban Concepts 30503, 30539
US Logic 30839
V
Venturer 30790
Vestel 30713, 30884, 31530
Victor 31597
Vieta 30705
Viewmaster 30862, 31224
Voxson 30690, 30730, 30774, 30831
Vtrek 31228
W
Waitec 31151, 31224, 31233
Walkvision 30717
Waltham 31530
Welkin 30831
Wellington 30713
Weltstar 30713
Wesder 30699
Wharfedale
30686, 30751, 30752, 30790,
31832
Wilson 30831, 31233
Windsor 30713
Windy Sam 30573
WIZE 31115
Woxter 31005, 31151, 31224
X
Xbox 30522, 31708
Xenius 30790
XLogic 30768, 31152, 31228
XMS 30770, 30788
Xoro 31183, 31250
Y
Yakumo 31004, 31056
Yamada
30872, 31004, 31056, 31151,
31158
Yamaha
30490, 30539, 30646, 30545,
31354
Yamakawa 30665, 30872, 31104
Yukai 30730, 31730
Z
Zenith
30503, 30591, 30741, 30869,
31906
Zeus 30784
DVD Recorder
1
4Kus 31158
A
Airis 31321
Akira 31321
Alba 31530
Apex Digital 31056
Aristona 30646
Aspire Digital 31168
B
Belson 31086
C
Cat 31421
cello 31730
Centrum 31227
Classic 31730
Coby 31086
Commax 31321
Conia 31321
CyberHome 31129, 31502
Cytron 31347
D
Denon 30490
Denver 31056
Digitrex 31056
DSE 31730
Durabrand 31502
E
E:max 31321
Ellion 31421
Eltax 31321
Emerson 30675
F
Ferguson 31730
Firstline 31530
Funai 30675
G
Gateway 31158
Go Video 30741, 31158, 31730
Goodmans 31530, 31730
GPX 30741
Grundig 31730
H
H & B 31421
Humax 30646
I
iLo 31348
J
JVC 31164, 31597
K
Kansas Technologies 31530
Kreisen 31421
KXD 31321
L
LG 30741
Lifetec 31347
LiteOn 31158
Loewe 30741
Lumatron 31321
Luxor 31730
M
Magnavox 30646, 30675
Matsui 31730
Maxent 31347
MBO 31730
Medion 31347
MiCO 30751
Mitsubishi 31403
Mustek 31730
N
NEC 31404
O
Oopla 31158
P
Palsonic 31056, 31321
Panasonic 30490, 31579
Philips 30646, 31158
Pioneer 30631
Polaroid 31086
ProVision 31321
Pye 30646
R
RCA 30522
Relisys 31347
Roadstar 31227
S
Sampo 31347
Samsung 30490, 31635
ScanMagic 31730
Schneider 30646
SEG 31530
Sensory Science 31158
Sharp 30630, 30675
Sony
31033, 31070, 31431, 31433,
31536
Star Clusters 31227
Sylvania 30675
T
Tangent 31321
Targa 31227
Teac 31227
Techwood 31530
Tevion 31227, 31347, 31730
Thomson 30551
Toshiba 31510
U
Universum 31227, 31530
V
Vestel 31530
Victor 31597
W
Waltham 31530
Y
Yakumo 31056
Yamada 31056, 31158
Yamaha 30646
Yukai 31730
Z
Zenith 30741
TV/DVD Combination
A
Akai 30695
Akura 31367
Alba 30695, 30884
Amstrad 31367
Apex Digital 30830
B
Black Diamond 30713, 30884
Broksonic 30695
Bush 30713, 30884
C
Centrum 30713
Citizen 30695
Crown 30713
D
D-Vision 31367
DMTech 31271
E
Elfunk 30713, 30884
Emerson 30675, 31268
ESA 31268
F
Ferguson 30695, 30713, 30884
Funai 31268
G
Goodmans 30713
Grandin 30713
Grundig 30539, 30695
H
Hitachi 31247
I
Insignia 31268
J
JDV 31367
JNC 31271
K
Konka 31192
L
Logik 30713, 30884
Luker 31367
Luxor 30713
M
Magnavox 31268
Matsui 30713, 30884
Maxim 31367
N
Naiko 31367
Narita 31367
Neovia 31271
O
Orion 30695
P
Pacific 30695
Panasonic 31490
Philips 30539, 30854, 31260
R
RCA 31022
S
Saivod 31367
Samsung 30899
Sansui 30695
Schneider 31367
SEG 30713, 30884
Sliding 31115
Stevison 31367
Sylvania 30630, 30675, 31268
T
Technica 31367
Thomson 30551
Toshiba 30695
U
United 30713, 30884, 31367
Universum 30713
V
Vestel 30884
TV/VCR Combination
T
Thomson 30551
TV/VCR/DVD Combination
A
Akai 30899
E
Emerson 30821
ESA 30821
M
Magnavox 30821
P
Panasonic 31362, 31462
R
RCA 31132
S
Sharp 30630
Superscan 30821
Sylvania 30821
Symphonic 30821
T
Toshiba 31045
PRESET CODE

AVR2808CIEU.indd 91 2007/06/20 8:59:04
DVD preset codes / Codes préréglés DVD
DENON Model No. / Modéle numéro
32134 (default / défaut) 30490
DVD-555
DVD-755
DVD-900
DVD-910
DVD-955
DVD-1000
DVD-1200
DVD-1500
DVD-1710
DVD-1910
DVD-1930CI
DVD-2200
DVD-2800
DVD-2800g
DVD-2900
DVD-2910
DVD-2930CI
DVD-3800
DVD-3910
DVD-3930CI
DVD-5900
DVD-5910
DVD-9000
DVM-715
DVM-1800
DVM-1805
DVM-1815
DVM-2815
DVM-4800
DVD-800
DVD-1600
DVD-2000
DVD-2500
DVD-3000
DVD-3300
[ ]
z
: Preset codes set upon shipment
from the factory.
[ ]
z
: Les codes préréglés différent en
fonctiom des livraison de l’usine.
PRESET CODE

AVR2808CIEU.indd 92 2007/06/20 8:59:04
AVR2808CIEU.indd 93 2007/06/20 8:59:05
AVR2808CIEU.indd 94 2007/06/20 8:59:05
AVR2808CIEU.indd 95 2007/06/20 8:59:05
Denon Brand Company, D&M Holdings Inc.
Printed in Japan 00D 511 4666 005
TOKYO, JAPAN
www.denon.com
AVR2808CIEU.indd 96 2007/06/20 8:59:05
6


Need help? Post your question in this forum.

Forumrules


Report abuse

Libble takes abuse of its services very seriously. We're committed to dealing with such abuse according to the laws in your country of residence. When you submit a report, we'll investigate it and take the appropriate action. We'll get back to you only if we require additional details or have more information to share.

Product:

For example, Anti-Semitic content, racist content, or material that could result in a violent physical act.

For example, a credit card number, a personal identification number, or an unlisted home address. Note that email addresses and full names are not considered private information.

Forumrules

To achieve meaningful questions, we apply the following rules:

Register

Register getting emails for Denon AVR-2808CI at:


You will receive an email to register for one or both of the options.


Get your user manual by e-mail

Enter your email address to receive the manual of Denon AVR-2808CI in the language / languages: English as an attachment in your email.

The manual is 12,05 mb in size.

 

You will receive the manual in your email within minutes. If you have not received an email, then probably have entered the wrong email address or your mailbox is too full. In addition, it may be that your ISP may have a maximum size for emails to receive.

Others manual(s) of Denon AVR-2808CI

Denon AVR-2808CI User Manual - English - 93 pages


The manual is sent by email. Check your email

If you have not received an email with the manual within fifteen minutes, it may be that you have a entered a wrong email address or that your ISP has set a maximum size to receive email that is smaller than the size of the manual.

The email address you have provided is not correct.

Please check the email address and correct it.

Your question is posted on this page

Would you like to receive an email when new answers and questions are posted? Please enter your email address.



Info